Porsche 2020 992 OWM V2
Porsche 2020 992 OWM V2
Porsche 2020 992 OWM V2
WKD 992 02 20 20
911
Good to know – Driver’s Manual
WKD 992 02 20 20 11/2019 in this manual, your Porsche partner will be glad to > Notice on where you can find further important
provide information concerning correct operation information on a topic.
Porsche, the Porsche crest, 911, PCCB, PCM, PDK, and care of the items concerned.
PSM, PTM, Tequipment and other marks are regis- Airbag warning sticker
tered trademarks of Dr. Ing. h.c. F. Porsche AG. Warnings and symbols Child restraint system on
Printed in Germany. Various types of warnings and symbols are used in DANGER
passenger’s seat
Reprinting, even of excerpts, or duplication of any this manual.
type is only permissible with the written authorisa- Serious injury or death If a child restraint system is fitted on the passenger
tion of Dr. Ing. h.c. F. Porsche AG. DANGER seat, there is a danger of serious or fatal injury when
© Dr. Ing. h.c. F. Porsche AG the airbag is triggered.
Failure to observe warnings in the "Danger" category
Porscheplatz 1 e Never use a rearward-facing child restraint sys-
70435 Stuttgart will result in serious injury or death.
tem on the passenger’s seat with the front air-
Germany
Possible serious injury or bag activated as it poses a risk of injury and
WARNING death to the child.
On-board literature death
Always keep this on-board literature in the vehicle Failure to observe warnings in the "Warning" cate- > Please refer to chapter "Child Restraint Systems
and please hand it over to the new owner if you sell (Child Seats)" on page 73.
gory can result in serious injury or death.
your vehicle.
Do you have any questions, suggestions, or ideas for Possible moderate or
your vehicle or for the on-board literature? CAUTION
minor injury
Please write to us:
Dr. Ing. h.c. F. Porsche AG Failure to observe warnings in the "Caution" cate-
Vertrieb Customer Relations gory can result in moderate or minor injuries.
Porscheplatz 1
70435 Stuttgart Possible vehicle damage
NOTICE
Germany
Failure to observe warnings in the "Notice" category
Equipment
can result in damage to the vehicle.
Because our vehicles undergo continuous develop-
ment, equipment and specifications may not be as
illustrated or described by Porsche in this manual. Information
Items of equipment are sometimes optional or vary Additional information is indicated using the word
depending on the country in which the vehicle is "Information".
sold. For more information on retrofit equipment,
please contact your Porsche partner. b Conditions that must be met in order to use a
Because of different legal requirements in individual function.
countries, the equipment in your vehicle may vary e Instruction that you must follow.
from that described in this manual. Should your 1. If an instruction comprises several steps, these
Porsche be fitted with any equipment not described are numbered.
1
Layout of the Manual
Driver's Manual – Digital Contents Safety and Driving Pleasure Overviews
The Driver's Manual is available in Gain an overview and find the topics Find out how to enjoy your driving Familiarise yourself with components
digital form on-board in the vehicle you are looking for. pleasure safely. and controls.
and as an app. > From page 5 > From page 19
> From page 3
Browse through and gain additional Find out how components and con- Look for specific figures. Get straight to the information you
information about new functions. trols work and how to operate them. > From page 280 are looking for.
> From page 26 > From page 219
2
Driver's Manual - Digital
Further information about your vehicle is available (depending on country) in the on-board Driver's Manual in your vehicle and in the Porsche "Good to know" app:
Video instructions, interactive graphics, practical tips and functions in detail.
On-board App
You can find the Driver's Manual in the Porsche You can download the Driver's Manual from the
Communication Management (PCM) under: relevant app store by searching for Gut zu wis-
sen, Good to know or 车主指南:
Apple, the Apple logo, Apple CarPlay, iPhone, iPod, iOS, Siri and other designations of Apple are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.
App Store is a service mark of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.
3
Contents Brakes ................................................................................58 Porsche Connect .........................................................182
Cruise control (CC) ........................................................92
More Safety and More Driving Pleasure ...................5 Driving programmes ...................................................100 Luggage and Transport
Front axle lift system ..................................................113 Cupholders .......................................................................94
Overview Illustrations Luggage compartment ..............................................146
Cockpit ..............................................................................20 HOLD function ..............................................................119
Interior lighting .............................................................127 Roof Transport System ..............................................195
Control Panel ...................................................................21 Smoker's Package .......................................................210
Driver's Cockpit ...............................................................19 Lane Change Assist (LCA) ........................................132
Lane Keep Assist .........................................................137 Socket .............................................................................211
Filler Openings ................................................................24 Storage ...........................................................................219
Overhead Console ..........................................................23 Lights ..............................................................................140
Switch Panel ....................................................................22 Night View Assist ........................................................164 Mobility and Breakdown Assistance
ParkAssist ......................................................................166 Battery ...............................................................................52
Practical Tips Porsche Active Safe (warning and brake assist) Brake Fluid ........................................................................57
Practical Tips ...................................................................26 ............................................................................................171 Car Care .............................................................................61
Opening and locking Porsche Active Suspension Management (PASM) Coolant ..............................................................................90
Central locking ................................................................67 ............................................................................................174 Emergency Call System .............................................103
Convertible top ...............................................................82 Porsche Stability Management (PSM) ..................185 Engine oil ........................................................................108
Driver's Key ......................................................................97 Porsche Vehicle Tracking System (PVTS) ............188 Flat Tyre ..........................................................................110
Engine Compartment Lid ..........................................107 Spoiler .............................................................................212 Fuses ...............................................................................114
Garage door opener (HomeLink®) ...........................117 Sport Chrono Stopwatch ...........................................213 Jack and Lifting Platform ..........................................128
Luggage Compartment Lid .......................................149 Starting and Stopping the Engine ..........................216 Jump-lead Starting .....................................................129
Slide/Tilt Roof ..............................................................206 Traffic Sign Detection ................................................231 Refuelling .......................................................................191
Windows ........................................................................273 Transmission .................................................................233 Screenwash ...................................................................199
Windscreen Wipers .....................................................275 Tests on Test Stands ..................................................227
Air Conditioning and Ergonomics Towing ............................................................................228
Airbag Systems ...............................................................36 Instrument Cluster and PCM
Driving Data Display (Trip Information) ...................99 Tyres and Wheels ........................................................238
Automatically Controlled 2-Zone Air Conditioning
...............................................................................................43 Instrument Cluster ......................................................120 Technical data
Child Restraint Systems (Child Seats) .....................73 Porsche Communication Management (PCM) ... 175 Radio equipment in accordance with 2014/53/EU
Mirror ...............................................................................155 Vehicle Settings ...........................................................246 ............................................................................................288
Personal Settings ........................................................169 Warning and Information Messages ......................255 Radio equipment outside European countries ....292
Roll-over protection (Cabriolet) ..............................194 Entertainment and Communication Software licences ........................................................297
Seat Belts .......................................................................200 Media ...............................................................................152 Technical Data ..............................................................280
Seats ................................................................................203 Telephone ......................................................................222 Index ................................................................................303
Steering Wheel .............................................................217 Voice Control ................................................................248
Sun Visors ......................................................................221
Navigation and Connectivity
Driving and Driver Assistance Systems Apple CarPlay ..................................................................39
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) ...................................29 Apps ...................................................................................41
Alarm System ..................................................................38 Device Manager ..............................................................96
Auto Start Stop function ..............................................49 Navigation ......................................................................159
4
Same Driving Pleasure, More Safety
Same Driving Pleasure, More – Tyres are not damaged, have the right pres- and bulges. Remember to also check the side
Safety sure and sufficient tread
– Headlights, brake lights and direction indica-
walls of the tyres.
e If in doubt, have the tyres and the entire wheel
Your Porsche: Extreme performance, extreme tors all work checked by a qualified specialist workshop.
sportiness. A fascinating experience - no doubt – Aerodynamic components are undamaged e Do not continue driving with damaged tyres.
about it. But only if you can remain relaxed whatever – Wiper blades are intact Have damaged tyres replaced immediately: Visit
the situation. Therefore, for us safety is also a matter – Windscreen/windows are unobstructed a qualified workshop. Porsche recommends a
of maximum quality. without any cracks or damage to the glass Porsche partner as they have trained workshop
Here you can find out how you can play your part in – Exterior and interior mirrors are intact and personnel and the necessary parts and tools.
ensuring safety while driving your Porsche. correctly positioned
– Sensors and cameras are without cracks or Adjusting the tyre pressure
Perfect technology: a prerequisite damage
– Cooling air ducts, sensors and cameras are
for your safety not obstructed (e.g. through films or stone
High-quality materials and excellent workmanship shields, number plate holders)
will keep your car on the road for many years to
e Only use telephones or 2-way radios inside the
come. In order to achieve its full potential, the ve-
vehicle with an external antenna connected, so
hicle requires attention and care. That way, you will
as not to exceed the limits for electromagnetic
also be able to rely on your Porsche in critical
radiation in the vehicle.
situations.
Checking tyres for damage
Checking the vehicle for damage and correct
functioning Excessively low or high tyre pressure irreparably
damages the tyre and the wheel, lengthens the
braking distance and greatly increases the risk of an
accident. If the tyre pressure is too low, fuel con-
sumption can increase noticeably.
e Adapt tyre pressure to suit your specific tyres
and the payload.
> Please refer to chapter "Technical Data" on
page 280.
Damaged tyres may burst while you are driving. You > Please refer to chapter "Tyres and Wheels"
may lose control of the vehicle. on page 238.
A vehicle with technical defects may be the cause of
e Depending on how often you drive and the con- e Make sure that the settings in the Tyre Pressure
accidents due to faulty operating behaviour, for Monitoring menu on the multi-function display
ditions, check tyres regularly – at least once a
example. correspond to the tyres fitted on the vehicle and
month – for foreign bodies, nicks, cuts, cracks
e Check your vehicle regularly (at least once a load condition of the vehicle.
month and before any long journey), to ensure it > Please refer to chapter "Configuring Tyre
is in good technical condition. In particular, pay
attention to the following:
5
Same Driving Pleasure, More Safety
Pressure Monitoring (TPM) in the PCM" on Checking aerodynamic components > Please refer to chapter "Windscreen Wipers"
page 239. on page 275.
e When a red tyre pressure warning appears on the
instrument cluster: stop immediately in a suit- Maintenance and modifications only by quali-
able place and check the tyres for damage. Do fied specialist workshops
not continue driving with damaged tyres. If nec-
essary, remedy the damage with tyre sealant.
> Please refer to chapter "Flat Tyre" on
page 110.
6
Same Driving Pleasure, More Safety
Diagnostic socket that have been manufactured according to the Your lifesaver: Using seat belts correctly
specifications and production requirements of
Porsche. This ensures that your vehicle remains
reliable and safe to drive, and that no conse-
quential damage occurs to your vehicle. You can
obtain these parts from a Porsche partner or a
qualified specialist workshop. Porsche recom-
mends a Porsche partner as they have trained
workshop personnel and the necessary parts and
tools.
e Only use accessories that are from the Porsche
The diagnostic socket is used to connect diagnostic Tequipment range or have been tested and ap- Seat belts can only protect you from injury if they are
equipment in qualified specialist workshops. proved by Porsche. For information on Porsche used correctly and in good working order.
External equipment (e.g. navigation units, head-up Tequipment: Contact your Porsche partner.
displays) connected to the diagnostic socket can Information
impair the function of the vehicle systems and run Information
down or damage the battery (exhaustive discharge) Severe injuries can occur at speeds as low as
when the ignition is switched off. The external If other spare parts or accessories are used, Porsche 30 km/h (20 mph) if you are not wearing a seat belt.
equipment and cables can obstruct clearance refuses to accept liability for any damage caused by Safety systems only protect you when working in
around the pedals or become caught between the their use. Even if the supplier of other spare parts or combination. For example, airbags can only provide
pedals when braking or changing direction. accessories is a recognised supplier, the safety of the right protection if the safety belt is also put on
e Do not connect any equipment to the diagnostic your vehicle may still be compromised. correctly.
socket. Using spare parts or accessories that are not ap-
e Do not place any equipment or cables in the
proved by Porsche may invalidate your vehicle e Always fasten seat belts tightly, even on short
warranty. journeys.
driver’s footwell.
e Use one seat belt to secure one occupant only.
Spare parts for your Porsche e Remove bulky items of clothing (e.g. winter
Loading, safety systems, children coats).
in the vehicle: know-how for Por- e Do not place the seat belts across hard or fragile
objects (e.g. glasses or ball-point pens).
sche drivers
e Do not twist the seat belts.
With your Porsche, you can accelerate to over 100
e Always make sure unused seat belts are com-
km/h (62 mph) in just a few seconds. With this
pletely retracted.
much power at your disposal, you should do every-
thing to ensure safety before you set off. e For pregnant women: Pregnant drivers or pas-
sengers should position the lap belt under the
Therefore, put the same passion into getting reading
belly and the shoulder belt taut over the chest.
for a trip as you do into driving.
e If worn or damaged, have the belt, belt buckle or
e Only use genuine Porsche spare parts for your attachment points replaced.
vehicle, or spare parts of an equivalent quality
7
Same Driving Pleasure, More Safety
> Please refer to chapter "Seat Belts" on the steering wheel or in the vicinity of the e Always secure items for transport.
page 200. airbags. e Always stow loads securely, e.g. in the luggage
e Do not route any cables of additional electrical compartment.
Airbag system equipment in the vicinity of the airbag wiring. e Stow small items in storage compartments and
e Do not remove airbag components (e.g. steering close them all. Never let objects protrude from
wheel, front seats, roof trims). storage compartments.
e Do not modify the wiring or components of the e Never place objects on top of the dashboard.
airbag system. e Secure loads with tie-down belts (tear strength
> Please refer to chapter "Airbag Systems" on at least 700 kg).
page 36. e Do not transport any heavy objects in open stor-
age compartments.
Securing all objects in the passenger e Also provide your passengers with all information
compartment regarding safety measures.
For correctly loading your Porsche and stowing
Airbag systems can only perform their protective
items:
function if all occupants have their seat belts fas-
> Please refer to chapter "Storage" on page 219.
tened and maintain the correct seat position. Ob-
> Please refer to chapter "Luggage compartment"
jects and luggage must be stowed safely.
on page 146.
e Make sure that there are no persons, animals or
objects between the occupants and the area into Preventing crushing hazards
which the airbag deploys.
e Keep a distance from the airbags, e.g. do not lean
against the inside of the doors. Always keep your
feet in the footwell when driving. Do not put your An unsecured or incorrectly positioned load in the
feet on the dashboard or seat surface. passenger compartment can slide around as a result
Airbag systems that have been tampered with offer of braking or acceleration as well as during changes
no protection. They may either not trigger or be of direction or an accident. This can endanger and
triggered in an uncontrolled manner. An airbag that injure vehicle occupants.
triggers in an uncontrolled manner can cause serious
injuries.
Information
e Do not use seat covers. Persons or animals can get caught or crushed if they
e Do not attach any additional trims or stickers to In the event of a collision at 50 km/h (30 mph), for are in the range of movement of the vehicle parts
example, unsecured objects can be thrown forwards below. These parts include the following, among
with a force up to 50 times their weight. For exam- others:
ple, a 1.5 litre bottle of water has a force of up to – Adjustable front seats
75 kg as it flies through the interior.
– Doors
– Window
– Slide/tilt roof
8
Same Driving Pleasure, More Safety
– Flaps and lids Using a child restraint system safely Avoid distraction
– Lids of storage compartments
e Make sure that no persons or animals are within
the range of movement when moving these ve-
hicle components.
Child restraint systems can only work if they are If you use the PCM or other components in the ve-
correctly installed. hicle while driving, you are distracted from the traffic
e Only use child restraint systems that are ap- and may not react in time to dangerous situations.
proved for your Porsche. For your safety, some functions are only available
e Before you use a child restraint system: Read and when the vehicle is stationary.
follow the child restraint system manufacturer's e Never adjust the mirror, seat or steering wheel
instructions as well as this manual. while driving. The seat or steering wheel may
Children often cannot judge dangers correctly and
may behave inappropriately in dangerous situations. > Please refer to chapter "Child Restraint Sys- move unexpectedly far. You may lose control of
tems (Child Seats)" on page 73. the vehicle. Adjust the mirror, seat and steering
Children can accidentally trigger automatic settings wheel position before driving.
(e.g. seat adjustment) and suffer injury. Children e Only use the multi-function steering wheel, in-
may not be able to exit the vehicle in emergency Safe and competent driving: al- fotainment system, etc. while driving if the traf-
situations e.g. overheated passenger compartment. ways make the right decision fic situation permits. In case of doubt, stop the
This can be life-threatening, especially for small vehicle when it is safe to do so.
Your Porsche is an all-rounder. From Launch Control
children.
to the emergency braking function – once you let it e Do not use mobile phones or other mobile devi-
e Keep children away from live or hot parts, e.g. the ces while driving.
loose, everything is possible. However, at the end of
exhaust tailpipe.
the day, you are responsible for keeping your power e Always use hands-free equipment.
e Keep toxic materials, e.g. tyre sealing compound, house under control. e Do not reach through the steering wheel spokes
engine oil, out of the reach of children.
while driving. Otherwise, you may not be able to
e Do not leave children in the vehicle unattended. react in time to dangerous situations.
9
Same Driving Pleasure, More Safety
Awareness of braking behaviour in rain and Responding correctly to uneven running or > Please refer to chapter "Instrument Cluster"
snow vibrations on page 120.
Damage to the tyres or vehicle can lead to uneven Driving with summer tyres
running or vibration while driving. You may lose
Parking or manoeuvring at outside temperatures
control of the vehicle. below 15 °C may result in noises.
e Reduce your speed immediately, but without
e Change to winter tyres when outside tempera-
braking sharply. tures are below 7 °C.
e Stop the vehicle and check the tyres. If you can-
not find a cause for the problem, continue driving Assistance systems and their limitations
carefully and have the problem fixed. Visit a
qualified specialist workshop. Porsche recom-
mends a Porsche partner as they have trained
In heavy rain, while driving through water or after workshop personnel and the necessary parts and
leaving a car wash, a film of water may form on the tools.
brakes, delaying the braking action and requiring in-
creased pressure on the brake pedal. Keeping tyres in safe condition
Moreover, after a long drive in wintry road condi- Damaged tyres can burst, especially at high speeds.
tions, a coating may form on brake discs and pads Prevent damage to tyres by driving in a manner that
that significantly reduces friction and therefore also protects your tyres.
the braking action. e Cross kerb edges slowly and at right angles if
e Brake the brakes dry, especially before parking possible. Your Porsche is equipped with assistance systems
the vehicle. This will prevent corrosion. e Avoid driving over steep or sharp kerbs. that enhance your safety and driving comfort.
e Corroded brakes tend to "judder". If braking
None of these systems can overcome the laws of
Running in new tyres physics affecting driving.
comfort is noticeably impaired, have the brake
system checked.
New tyres do not yet have maximum adhesion to the e Do not be tempted to take greater risks with your
road surface and tend to slip. safety. Assistance systems cannot reduce the
e Run in new tyres at a moderate speed for the risk of accidents caused by an inappropriate
Suitable tyres and appropriate driving style first 200 km (125 miles). driving style.
Driving with winter tyres e Assistance systems are no substitute for your
Winter tyres are subject to maximum speeds. If you careful attention. Always remain attentive so that
exceed the maximum permitted speed, a tyre may you can react appropriately to the traffic
burst. situation.
e Always observe the maximum permitted speed e Familiarise yourself with assistance systems be-
for the tyres you are using. fore you use them.
e Affix a sticker showing the maximum permitted Here you can find the Assistance systems at a
speed in the driver’s field of vision. Observe glance:
country-specific laws.
> Please refer to chapter "Tyres and Wheels" on e Setting the maximum permitted speed as the
page 238. speed limit via the instrument cluster:
10
Same Driving Pleasure, More Safety
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) > p. 29 Emergency braking function e Adapt your driving style to the changed vehicle
handling.
Anti-lock brake system (ABS) > p. 185 e Do not drive at a speed of more than 130 km/h
(80 mph) with the roof transport system fitted
HOLD function > p. 119 and loaded.
e Do not drive at a speed of more than 180 km/h
Automatic headlights, PDLS Plus, > p. 140 (110 mph) with the roof transport system fitted
dynamic high beam but not loaded.
e Do not exceed the maximum gross weight and
Night View Assist > p. 164 axle load.
ParkAssist, reversing camera, > p. 166 You can carry out emergency braking using the Driving off with Launch Control
Surround View electric parking brake, for example if the conven-
tional footbrake is defective.
Porsche Active Safe (PAS) > p. 171 Emergency braking takes place with very high brak-
ing power. As a result, the traffic behind may be
Porsche Active Suspension Man- > p. 174 endangered.
agement (PASM) e Only use the emergency braking function in an
emergency situation and not during normal
Porsche Stability Management > p. 185 driving.
(PSM) e For emergency braking, pull and hold switch .
To stop braking, release the switch.
Porsche Vehicle Tracking System > p. 188 > Please refer to chapter "Brakes" on page 58. The vehicle accelerates very quickly with Launch
(PVTS) Control activated when driving off. In certain cir-
Driving with a loaded vehicle cumstances (poor road conditions, lack of attention,
Tyre Pressure Monitoring (TPM) > p. 238 etc.) you may lose control of the vehicle or endanger
other road users.
Lane Keep Assist > p. 137 e Only use Launch Control on public roads if road
and traffic conditions permit.
Lane Change Assist (LCA) > p. 132 e Do not endanger other road users when driving
off with Launch Control.
Cruise control > p. 92 > Please refer to chapter "Transmission" on
page 233.
> p. 231
Traffic sign detection e By switching the sports exhaust system to the
sound-optimised mode, the very sporty driving
The handling of your Porsche changes depending on style is accompanied by a significantly increased
the vehicle load. If you are using a roof transport noise level. Therefore, assume your social re-
system, there is also greater wind resistance. sponsibility and respect nearby residents, espe-
cially at night.
11
Same Driving Pleasure, More Safety
Reacting correctly to warning signals e Fire, naked flames and smoking are prohibited Toxic exhaust gases
when refuelling.
e Do not inhale fuel vapours.
e Do not let fuel come into contact with skin or
clothing.
> Please refer to chapter "Refuelling" on
page 191.
If a spare canister in the vehicle is damaged in an
accident, fuel may leak out of it and ignite or
explode.
e Do not carry spare canisters in the vehicle.
If the systems detect malfunctions or defective Exhaust gas contains colourless and odourless car-
parts, your vehicle warns you with lights or mes- Hazardous fluids bon monoxide, which is toxic even in low
sages on the instrument cluster or PCM. If you concentrations.
ignore vehicle warning signals, the risk of accidents, e Turn off the engine when the vehicle is station-
injuries and damage to the vehicle may increase. ary. Never leave the engine running unnecessa-
e Familiarise yourself with the meaning of warning rily in confined spaces.
lights and messages before starting to drive so e Perform work with the engine running only out-
that you can respond correctly to the warnings doors or with suitable extraction systems for the
Stop driving if necessary. exhaust gases.
> Please refer to chapter "Warning and Infor-
mation Messages" on page 255. Parking the vehicle safely
> Please refer to chapter "Instrument Cluster" Not only fuel, but also engine and transmission oil,
on page 120. battery acid, coolant and brake fluid are also haz-
ardous to health.
Hazards during refuelling e Only work on the vehicle in the open or in well-
ventilated spaces.
e Fluid containers must be labelled appropriately
and must be kept out of reach for children.
e Dispose of residues in an environmentally
friendly manner and according to regulations.
Engine oil can ignite. Cloths containing residues of
engine oil that are thrown away or stored without If the vehicle is not parked correctly, it can roll away
ventilation can ignite by themselves and cause a fire. uncontrolled, endangering people or causing mate-
rial damage.
e Soak up spilled engine oil with cloths.
Before you leave the vehicle:
e Keep cloths saturated with engine oil in a venti-
Fuel is highly flammable and can deflagrate or ex- lated place until they are disposed of. e Activate the electric parking brake.
plode. Fuel and fuel vapours are also harmful to e Vehicles with PDK: Activate the transmission
health. parking lock via the P button on the selector
12
Same Driving Pleasure, More Safety
lever. If the operating mode P is flashing on the Do not use voice control in an emergency the inspection interval has elapsed, functionality
instrument cluster, the parking lock is not cor- is no longer guaranteed.
rectly engaged. Press the P button on the selec- e Observe the operating instructions on the fire
tor lever again or switch off the ignition. extinguisher.
When the ignition is switched off, the transmis- e Observe the safety instructions on the leaflet
sion parking lock is automatically engaged. supplied by the fire extinguisher manufacturer on
e Vehicles with manual transmission: Engage first the extinguisher handle.
or reverse gear. e The fire extinguisher should be checked by a
The exhaust system is very hot when the engine is specialist workshop every 1-2 years to ensure
running and for a while after the engine has been correct operation.
stopped. Risk of burns and fire! e Have the fire extinguisher refilled after use.
e Do not park your vehicle in places where com- In emergency situations, stress may cause your
bustible materials, such as dry grass or leaves, voice to change so that voice control does not rec- Caution when working on the vehicle
can come into contact with the hot exhaust ognise your instructions.
system. e Do not use voice control in an emergency.
e If you are standing behind the vehicle, maintain a
safe distance from the tailpipes. Removing the fire extinguisher
e Make sure that children do not burn themselves
on the tailpipes.
13
Same Driving Pleasure, More Safety
Jump-lead starting
Unsuitable jump leads or an incorrect starting pro- Vehicles with manual transmission1 After a collision
cedure can cause a short circuit and lead to a fire. There is an increased risk of accident when towing.
In addition, there are risks of injury in the engine Power assistance may not be available, so that
compartment due to parts that may start up auto- steering requires greater effort. If the brake booster
matically, such as radiator fans. has failed, you will require a great deal of force for
Before providing or receiving jump starting: braking.
> Please refer to chapter "Jump-lead Starting" on e Exercise the utmost caution when towing if the
page 129. engine has stopped or if power assistance or the
brake booster has failed.
e Do not tow vehicles with defective brakes.
> Please refer to chapter "Towing" on
page 228. The safety systems may not be operational (e.g.
seat-belt pretensioners and airbags) after a collision.
The safety systems can then no longer protect you.
1. Equipment may be available for use only at a later time or may only be available in certain markets.
14
Same Driving Pleasure, More Safety
e Have the safety systems checked even if they Running in new brake pads Vehicles with front axle lift system: The body can be
were not triggered. raised by approx. 40 mm at the front of the vehicle
e Always have triggered safety systems replaced. (front edge of front spoiler).
Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Porsche
recommends a Porsche partner as they have Driving on race circuits
trained workshop personnel and the necessary
parts and tools.
15
Same Driving Pleasure, More Safety
Brake pads and brake discs are subjected to very – Does the vehicle require technical adjustments? status of a component, module, system or environ-
high stress when driving on a race circuit. – Is the fuel octane rating sufficient? ment such as:
e If the brake fluid is more than 12 months old: – Do the headlights need to be changed to left/ – Operating states of system components (e.g. fill
Replace brake fluid before driving on a race right-hand traffic? levels)
circuit.
> Please refer to chapter "Vehicle Settings" on – Status messages about the vehicle and its indi-
e Have the brake pads and brake discs checked for vidual components (e.g. wheel revolutions,
page 246.
wear before and after driving on race circuits. speed, deceleration, lateral acceleration)
Tyres Data processing in the vehicle – Malfunctions and faults in important system
components (e.g. lights, brakes)
Tyres are also subjected to very high loads when
driving on a race circuit. – Information about events that can damage the
vehicle
e Have tyres checked for wear before and after
driving on race circuits. – The vehicle response in special driving situations
(e.g. triggering an airbag, activation of the
e Do not fit racing tyres. Racing tyres are not ap-
stability control system)
proved by Porsche.
– Environmental conditions (e.g. temperature)
Engine oil
In addition to providing the actual vehicle function,
e Check the engine oil level before and after driving
this data is used to detect and correct faults and
on race circuits.
enables the manufacturer to optimise vehicle func-
> Please refer to chapter "Engine oil" on Electronic control units are installed in your vehicle. tions. Most of this data is volatile and is only pro-
page 108. Some of these are required for the operational safety cessed in the vehicle itself. Only a small part of the
of your vehicle, while others provide assistance while data is stored in event or fault memories. Moreover,
Before driving abroad driving (driver assistance systems). Moreover, your your vehicle offers comfort and entertainment
vehicle offers comfort and entertainment functions functions which are also made possible through
which are also made possible through electronic electronic control units.
control units.
Your vehicle has a unique chassis number. This ve- Read-out of technical data
hicle identification number (VIN) can be traced back You can have data that is only stored locally in the
to the present owner and to previous owners of the vehicle read out with the help of technical experts, e.
vehicle through the local authorities within the g. in a workshop, for a certain fee if necessary. To
European Union. There are also other ways of tracing comply with statutory regulations, Porsche - as the
data collected from the vehicle back to the owner or manufacturer - may be required to release data
driver, e.g. using the registration number. stored by the manufacturer in so far as is necessary
Not all Porsche models are sold in all countries. As a at the request of government bodies in individual
result, spare parts may not be available, or the Por- Storing technical data in the vehicle cases (e.g. investigation of an offence).
sche Partner may not be able to carry out all repair Electronic control units have data memories that can When having your vehicle serviced, service network
work. temporarily or permanently store technical informa- employees (e.g. workshops, breakdown services,
Find out the following information before driving tion about vehicle status, component stress, servic- manufacturers) can read out the technical informa-
abroad: ing requirements, events or faults. Generally tion from the vehicle. Services include e.g. repair
– Can the vehicle be repaired if it breaks down? speaking, this technical information documents the services, service processes, warranty claims and
16
Same Driving Pleasure, More Safety
quality assurance measures. The data is read out for this depends on the app and the operating sys-
using a legally prescribed connection for OBD (on- tem on your mobile phone.
board diagnosis) in the vehicle. The data is collected,
processed and used by the relevant service network Use of online services
personnel and may be sent to Porsche in order to If your vehicle has a wireless network connection,
comply with product monitoring obligations or to this can be used to exchange data between your
improve quality for example. The fault and event vehicle, the surrounding area and other systems. You
memories in the vehicle can be reset by a repair can connect to the wireless network via the send
workshop in the context of repair or service and receive unit in the vehicle or via your connected
operations. mobile devices (e.g. mobile phone). Online functions
can be used via this wireless network connection.
Using functions in the vehicle These include online services and applications/apps
Within the scope of the selected equipment options, that are available to you through Porsche or other
you are able to enter information such as multimedia providers.
and address book data or navigation destinations For Porsche online services, the various functions
and other settings in the vehicle comfort and info- are described at a suitable place (e.g. the Porsche
tainment functions. This data may be stored locally Connect website) and the related data protection
in the vehicle or it may be contained on a device legislation information is provided. Personal data can
which you have connected to the vehicle (e.g. mobile be used for the provision of online services. The re-
phone, USB stick or MP3 player). Where this data quired data exchange takes place via a protected
has been stored in the vehicle, you can delete it at connection, e.g. with the Porsche IT systems set up
any time. This data is only sent to third parties at for this purpose. Collection, processing and use of
your request and particularly while using online personal data beyond that required for the provision
services, only in accordance with the settings you of services takes place exclusively on the basis of a
have selected. legal authorisation or consent.
If your vehicle has the required equipment, you can Usually, you can activate or deactivate the (often
control your connected mobile phone or another fee-based) services and functions and in some
mobile device using the controls integrated in the cases, even the entire data connection in the vehicle.
vehicle. Picture and sound from your mobile phone Excluded from this are in particular functions and
can be output via the multimedia system. Certain services required by law.
information can also be transferred to your mobile If the option exists to use the online services of other
phone. This includes, depending on the relevant type providers, these are the responsibility of and subject
of integration, e.g. general vehicle information or to the data protection policy and terms of usage of
position data. This allows optimal use of selected the relevant provider. Porsche has no influence on
apps on the mobile phone, e.g. for using a navigation the data exchanged in these cases. Please therefore
system or playing music. Active access to the ve- obtain information from the relevant service provider
hicle data via the mobile phone does not take place. on the type, scope and purpose of such data collec-
The type of subsequent data processing is deter- tion and the use of personal data in the context of
mined by the provider of the relevant app being third-party services.
used. Whether and which settings you can configure
17
Overview Illustrations
On the following pages, you will find overview
illustrations of all areas of the vehicle, with a brief
explanation. Further information can be found on the
relevant page.
18
Driver's Cockpit
Driver's Cockpit
A Door opener > p. 67
B Memory buttons > p. 169
Personal settings
C Central locking buttons > p. 70
D Power windows > p. 273
E Light buttons > p. 140
F Overhead console > p. 23
G Exterior mirror adjustment > p. 155
H Ignition lock > p. 216
I Engine compartment lid release > p. 107
Luggage compartment lid release > p. 149
J Steering wheel adjustment > p. 217
K Seat adjustment > p. 203
19
Cockpit
Cockpit
A Direction indicators and high beam > p. 143
B Gearshift paddles > p. 233
C Instrument cluster > p. 120
D Windscreen wipers > p. 275
E Sport Chrono stopwatch > p. 213
F Porsche Communication Management > p. 175
(PCM)
G Air vents > p. 46
H Glove box lock > p. 219
Airbag deactivation in the glove box > p. 37
I Cruise control > p. 92
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) > p. 29
J Voice controls, infotainment, instrument > p. 122
cluster
K Heated steering wheel > p. 217
L Telephone controls, infotainment, instru- > p. 122
ment cluster
M Mode switch > p. 100
N Switch panel > p. 22
O Air-conditioning upper control panel > p. 21
P Lower control panel > p. 21
Q Ashtray > p. 210
Cupholder > p. 94
R Armrest, storage compartment > p. 220
S Electric parking brake > p. 58
20
Control Panel
Control Panel
A Switch PCM on and off > p. 175
Adjust the volume
B Air-conditioning control panel > p. 43
C Rotary push button (for operating the > p. 178
PCM)
D Parking lock > p. 233
E Manual shifting mode > p. 234
F Seat heating/seat ventilation > p. 205
G Control panel for slide/tilt roof > p. 206
Convertible top > p. 82
21
Switch Panel
Switch Panel
A Front axle ride-height lift system > p. 113
B Quick access button (◊ button) for indi- > p. 246
vidual function assignment
C Hazard warning lights > p. 145
D Porsche Stability Management (PSM) > p. 185
E Porsche Active Suspension Management > p. 174
(PASM) with Porsche Dynamic Chassis
Control (PDCC)
F Driving programme WET mode > p. 100
G SPORT driving programme > p. 100
H Porsche Active Suspension Management > p. 174
(PASM)
I Sports exhaust system > p. 100
22
Overhead Console
Overhead Console
A Reading lights > p. 127
B Button for interior/reading light > p. 127
C Interior light (lighting on the control > p. 127
panel)
D SOS button > p. 103
E Automatic dimming function button > p. 158
F PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF/ON warning > p. 37
light
23
Filler Openings
Filler Openings
A Brake fluid > p. 57
B Washer fluid > p. 199
C Coolant > p. 90
D Engine oil > p. 108
24
Practical Tips
On the following pages, you will find practical tips on
the selected area of your vehicle.
25
Practical Tips
Practical Tips
General Operation Porsche Advanced Cockpit and Porsche Communication Management (PCM)
Topic Tip
Operating assistance systems Assistance systems can be switched on and off via the PCM under ASSIST . Preliminary settings for the
assistance systems can be made under ASSIST e Options e Assistance system settings.
Making vehicle settings General vehicle settings can be made under CAR e CONTROL e Vehicle (vehicle settings) or under CAR
e CONTROL e Displays (touch display PCM and instrument cluster settings).
Operating the instrument cluster The displays integrated on the left and right in the instrument cluster are displayed by turning and pressing the
right-hand rotary knob on the multi-function steering wheel.
Using shortcut buttons (◊ buttons) The quick access buttons (◊ buttons) on the multi-function steering wheel/centre console switch panel can be
freely assigned to a variety of vehicle and infotainment functions (e.g. in radio/media playback, navigation etc.).
Quick access via the Info widget and The Info widget and the homescreen provide fast access to the most important vehicle and infotainment
homescreen functions and can also be individually adapted.
Opening the Device Manager Connections can be managed centrally using the Device Manager (e.g. connect phone or Bluetooth® audio
player).
e Select or in the footer (depending on the connection status).
Activating voice control The button on the steering wheel activates different functions, depending on the application:
– Short press: Voice control of the PCM is activated.
– Long press: Siri voice recognition is activated.
Switching between two connected mobile If a mobile phone is already connected to the PCM, a second mobile phone can also be connected to the PCM and
phones the user can switch between the two mobile phones.
e Select the currently connected mobile phone at the top right in the header. The two devices already con-
nected are displayed. e Select the desired mobile phone.
26
Practical Tips
Programming the garage door opener All functions for the programming and use of the integrated garage door opener can be found under CAR e
CONTROL e HomeLink®.
Programming the garage door opener If the battery voltage of the original remote control is inadequate, faults may occur in signal transmission. The
system in the vehicle then learns the wrong code, which will not be recognised reliably by the garage door
opening mechanism.
e Make sure that the battery in the original remote control for the garage door opener is new.
Switching upper ventilation field on or off The upper ventilation panel can be activated or deactivated via the PCM.
e CLIMATE e AIR e Centre
Adjusting the fresh air supply depending on Auto air circulation can be switch on or off via PCM.
the air quality e CLIMATE e AIR e Auto air circ.
Central locking
Topic Tip
When the vehicle is unlocked, only one door The setting for locking and unlocking the doors has been changed. All doors can be unlocked irrespective of the
is unlocked. selected setting.
e Press button on the driver's key twice within 5 seconds.
This setting can be changed under CAR e CONTROL e Vehicle e Locking.
27
Topics
On the following pages you will find topics listed in
alphabetical order.
28
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
29
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
A objects may not be detected in time or cannot be A vehicle changing lanes or cutting in will not be Vehicles with large overhangs
detected in the following situations: identified until it is completely in its own driving
B lane.
– in the case of vehicles that change lanes or cut in
C – in the case of vehicles with a small cross-section A narrow vehicle will not be detected or will be de-
or narrow vehicles tected too late.
D
– when driving into and out of bends
E Cornering and stationary vehicles
– in the case of stationary vehicles
F – in the case of vehicles with large overhangs
– in the case of pedestrians, cyclists and animals
G
– in the case of objects on the road
H – in the case of oncoming vehicles and cross traffic Fig. 4: Vehicles with large overhangs
I e Take action and brake if necessary. If there is a vehicle in front with a long overhang, e.g.
e Drive with extreme care and always pay attention a timber lorry, the radar sensor may not detect the
J to the traffic conditions and vehicle end of the vehicle or may detect it incorrectly.
K surroundings.
Operating principle
L
Adaptive cruise control (ACC) operates between ap-
Vehicles changing lanes or cutting in and
M prox. 30 and 210 km/h (20 and 130 mph) to auto-
narrow vehicles
matically maintain a selected speed and distance
N without you having to use the accelerator pedal.
O If a vehicle travelling at less than the selected speed
is detected in the same lane, ACC automatically
P maintains a specific distance. Adaptive cruise con-
Q trol applies the brakes if the distance to the vehicle
Fig. 3: Cornering (C) and stationary vehicles (D) ahead becomes too short, and accelerates if the
R When driving into and out of bends, vehicles will not distance increases.
S be detected or will be detected too late, or the sys- If the vehicle in front stops, ACC will slow down to a
tem will react to vehicles in adjacent lanes. stop and automatically move off again provided the
T A stationary vehicle or obstacle that appears sud- vehicle in front resumes motion within a certain time
U denly in the detection field of the radar sensor, e.g. frame. The driver assistance system's readiness to
after a vehicle in front changes lanes or at the end of move off is shown in the Speed & Assist display on
V a traffic jam, can only be detected by Adaptive the instrument cluster. Otherwise, automatic speed
W Cruise Control (ACC) to a limited extent. control and distance control can be resumed by the
driver.
X The speed of the vehicle can be increased at any
Y time by pressing the accelerator. The stored desired
Fig. 2: Vehicles changing lanes or cutting in (A) and narrow speed and distance are retained and set again after
Z vehicles (B) the accelerator pedal is released. The speed of the
30
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
31
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
32
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
33
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
34
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
35
Airbag Systems
A Airbag Systems Airbags protect the head, pelvis and upper body, injuries.
B Incorrect seat position or
while simultaneously damping the motion of the e Do not modify the wiring or components of the
DANGER driver and passengers in the impact direction in the airbag systems.
incorrectly stowed load
C event of frontal impact or side impact. e Do not route any cables of additional electrical
Airbag systems can perform their safety function The front airbags are installed under the padded equipment in the vicinity of the airbag wiring
D steering wheel on the driver’s side and in the dash-
only if all occupants are wearing seat belts and are harnesses.
E sitting in the correct position. Objects and luggage board on the passenger’s side. e Do not attach any additional trims or stickers in
must be stowed safely. The side airbags on the front seats are located in the the vicinity of the airbags.
F
e Always fasten the seat belts.
side of the seat side bolsters. e Do not use protective seat covers.
G
e Make sure that there are no persons, animals or
The head airbags are located in the side roof frame e Do not remove airbag components.
(Coupé models).
H objects between the driver or passengers and
The respective airbags could trigger depending on
the area into which the airbag inflates.
I
e Always hold the steering wheel by the outer rim.
the angle of impact and force of impact. Recognising faults
J e For airbags to give effective protection, they DANGER
No activation of already Faults are indicated by the red airbag warning light
must be a certain distance from the driver or triggered airbag systems on the instrument cluster.
K
passengers. Select a seat position that is not Consult a qualified specialist workshop in the fol-
L Airbag systems can be triggered only once.
unnecessarily close to the airbags. lowing cases:
e Do not lean against the inside of the doors (air- e Have triggered airbag systems replaced – The warning light does not come on when the
M immediately.
bag inflation area). ignition is switched on.
N e Objects must not protrude out of the door stor- e Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Porsche or
age compartments. recommends a Porsche partner as they have – The warning light does not go out when the
O
e Do not transport heavy objects on or in front of trained workshop personnel and the necessary ignition is on.
P the seats. parts and tools. or
Q e Do not place objects on top of the dashboard. – The warning light comes on while driving.
e Keep the glove box closed while driving. DANGER
Malfunction due to air-
Porsche recommends a Porsche partner as they
R e Always keep your feet in the footwell when driv- bags that have been
tampered with have trained workshop personnel and the necessary
S ing. Do not put feet on the dashboard or the seat parts and tools.
cushion.
Airbag systems that have been tampered with offer
T e Share all the information in this section with your
no protection. They may either not trigger or be
U passengers.
triggered in an uncontrolled manner. An airbag that
V triggers in an uncontrolled manner can cause serious
36
Airbag Systems
37
Alarm System
38
Apple CarPlay
39
Apple CarPlay
A Switching between Apple CarPlay trouser pocket, or similar. (Bluetooth® and WiFi
B and using the iPhone as an iPod functions must be activated).
If the connected iPhone is connected as an iPod, e To switch from another menu item to Ap-
C Apple CarPlay is not available. You can switch be- ple CarPlay, select Apple CarPlay .
D tween using the iPhone as an iPod and Apple CarPlay
using the Device Manager.
E Remove saved iPhone from device list
F 1. To call up the Device Manager, select or
1. Select or in the header (depending on
in the header (depending on the connec-
G the connection status) e Options .
tion status).
H 2. Select the desired device.
2. Select the Link of the iPhone you are using.
I
J Call up wireless Apple CarPlay
K (available depending on equip-
L ment and country)
M Wireless CarPlay enables the use of Apple CarPlay
without a cable. Wireless CarPlay supports only one
N active mobile phone at a time.
O b Bluetooth® function of the mobile phone is acti-
vated and is visible to other devices.
P b WiFi enabled on the mobile phone.
Q
1. In the headline or (depending on the
R connection status) in the menu under Connec-
S tion Assist e select Apple CarPlay orLink
.
T
2. Select the device from the list.
U
3. Confirm that Apple CarPlay is being used.
V
Apple CarPlay is opened. Available apps are
W displayed.
X If your iPhone has been connected once, Apple Car-
Play will start automatically when you enter the ve-
Y hicle. The mobile phone can thus remain in your bag,
Z
40
Apps
41
Apps
A Information
B Since vehicle-specific data can be accessed using
C the app, it is recommended to protect this data from
unauthorised access by third parties.
D
E
Porsche Road Trip app
F
The Porsche Road Trip app can be used to plan and
G book complete trips with all stopovers (for example,
the best viewing points, restaurants and hotels along
H the route as part of the individually created
I itinerary).
Further information at: www.porsche.com/connect
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
W
X
Y
Z
42
Automatically Controlled 2-Zone Air Conditioning
Automatically Controlled 2- A
Zone Air Conditioning B
C
Brief overview
D
This brief overview does not replace the compre-
hensive information provided under "Automatically E
Controlled 2-Zone Air Conditioning". Safety mes-
F
sages and warnings, in particular, are not replaced by
this brief overview. G
The air conditioning system can be adjusted both via H
the buttons in the centre console and the PCM.
> Please refer to chapter "Porsche Communication I
Management (PCM)" on page 175. J
K
Switch on A/C MAX mode (maximum air Depending on the country, A/C MAX mode can be > p. 45 W
conditioning) switched on using the button in the centre console X
or using the PCM touch display.
e Press button C. Y
– or – Z
43
Automatically Controlled 2-Zone Air Conditioning
45
Automatically Controlled 2-Zone Air Conditioning
A > Please refer to chapter "Using air conditioning Adjusting air vents Adjusting air distribution
settings for entire vehicle – SYNC mode" on
B page 47. Adjusting front air distribution
C
Setting air flow 1. CLIMATE e AIR
D
The selected air flow is shown in a bar display in the 2. Selecting air distribution:
E air conditioning display in the centre console above
button . The more bars that are displayed, the The air flows to the windscreen and the
F side windows.
more air flows into the passenger compartment.
G The air flows to the windscreen and the
Increasing and decreasing air flow side windows.
H
e Push button up or down. The air flows out from the centre vent
I Pressing button switches back to auto- and the side vents.
J matic mode.
If the air quantity was reduced so much that OFF
Adjusting upper ventilation panel
K appears on the air-conditioning display, the outside-
L air supply is interrupted and the air-conditioning
system is switched off.
M
Impaired vision with air Fig. 16: Adjusting air vents
N WARNING
flow OFF
Risk of damage to the air
NOTICE
O The windows can mist up if the air flow setting is vents.
OFF.
P e Do not fasten any objects (e.g. mobile phone
e In order to increase the air flow again, push but- cradles, plug-in air fresheners) to the air vents.
Q
ton up or switch on automatic mode again.
R
Opening and closing air vents
S
e Turn thumbwheel on the air vent up or down.
T
Changing air flow direction
U
e Swivel vent vanes in the desired direction.
V
Fig. 17: Adjusting the upper ventilation panel
W
The ventilation panel on top of the dashboard can be
X activated or deactivated separately. The direction of
the air flow can be manually adjusted in the hori-
Y
zontal plane. The air-conditioning system adjusts
Z the air flow automatically.
46
Automatically Controlled 2-Zone Air Conditioning
Switching air flow on or off Switching air-recirculation mode When air-recirculation mode is switched on, the A
1. CLIMATE e AIR
on and off manually button lights up red.
B
– or –
Impaired vision in man- C
2. Ventilation field selection. WARNING
ual air-recirculation e CLIMATE e AIR e
mode D
Changing air flow direction
e Swivel vent vanes in the desired direction. In extended manual air recirculation mode, the win-
Switching air-recirculation mode off manually E
dows may mist up. As no fresh air is supplied, the e Press button .
F
– or –
Setting type of climate control driver can get tired and become less attentive.
G
Press button .
The air flow can be adjusted in three stages for the e Do not switch on manual air-recirculation mode
– or –
entire passenger compartment in automatic mode. for an extended period. H
e CLIMATE e AIR e I
1. CLIMATE e AIR e Style In some countries, air-recirculation mode can be
switched on and off using the button in the centre J
2. Select the desired type of climate control. console or using the PCM touch display. Switching the ioniser on and off
K
b Vehicles with ioniser (depending on equipment).
Switching air-recirculation mode on manually
Setting the footwell temperature In regions with poor air quality – e.g. in large cities – L
The footwell temperature can be set cooler than ionisation can help achieve better air quality in the
M
overall passenger compartment temperature. passenger compartment.
Ionisation itself does not produce any odour. N
1. CLIMATE e AIR e Footwell
e Open centre vent. O
2. Select desired footwell temperature.
e CLIMATE e AIR QUALITY e Ioniser
P
Q
Switching automatic air-recircu-
lation on and off Using air conditioning settings for R
In automatic air-recirculation mode, the outside-air entire vehicle – SYNC mode S
supply is automatically controlled depending on the
e CLIMATE e AIR e SYNC T
air quality. At outside temperatures below approx. 5
SYNC mode is switched on or off. When SYNC U
°C, air-recirculation mode is deactivated automati-
mode is activated, the displayed values for the
cally to prevent the windows from misting.
passenger's side change to the driver's values. V
e CLIMATE e AIR e Auto air circ. W
Recommended air-conditioning settings for
Fig. 18: Switching air-recirculation mode on and off
lone drivers X
e Press button . e Switch on SYNC mode in PCM for maximum Y
passenger compartment comfort.
Z
47
Automatically Controlled 2-Zone Air Conditioning
D > Please refer to chapter "Personal Settings" on open risks damage to rubber seals.
page 169. e Once the heating function has switched off au-
E tomatically, do not switch on the rear window
and exterior mirror heating repeatedly for a peri-
F Defrosting windscreen od of 5 to 20 minutes.
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
O Fig. 20: Heated rear window/exterior mirror heating button
P
Switching on heated rear window and exterior
Q mirror heating
R b Engine is running.
Fig. 19: Defrosting windscreen
e Press button .
S The button lights up orange.
Switching defrost mode on
T e Press button . Depending on the outside temperature, rear window
and exterior mirror heating switches off automati-
U The button lights up orange.
cally after approx. 5 to 20 minutes.
The air flows to the windscreen and the front
V side windows. Switching off heated rear window and exteri-
W The windscreen is demisted or defrosted as or mirror heating
quickly as possible.
X e Press button .
Switching defrost mode off The orange lighting on the button goes out.
Y
e Press button .
Z
The orange lighting on the button goes out.
48
Auto Start Stop function
Auto Start Stop function Vehicles with manual transmis- The driver's door is closed and the driver's seat A
The engine stops automatically when the vehicle is sion1: Engine stop and engine belt is then fastened.
B
stopped, e.g. at traffic lights or in a traffic jam, if all – or –
preconditions for stopping the engine automatically
start The accelerator pedal is pressed with the driver's C
are met. The engine can also stop automatically door closed and the driver's seat belt fastened.
Engine stop D
when the vehicle stops while travelling at walking If the driver leaves the vehicle while the engine has
pace. The Auto Start Stop function thus helps to 1. Brake the vehicle with the footbrake. E
stopped automatically (driver's door open and pedals
save fuel. 2. Put the gearshift lever in neutral. released), the requirements specified above must be
3. Release the clutch pedal. F
The ignition stays on even when the engine switches detected within 30 seconds in order for the engine
off automatically. All safety functions are still The engine stops. to start and Auto Start Stop mode to be resumed. G
available. Switching off the Auto Start Stop function within 30
Engine start H
seconds after leaving the vehicle results in an engine
Preconditions for stopping the engine e Press clutch pedal. start only after the driver's door has been closed and I
automatically You can drive off normally. the driver's seat belt has been fastened. If none of
J
b Auto Start Stop function switched on. these requirements are met, the engine has to be
b Engine, transmission and air conditioning are at Information started manually 30 seconds after leaving the ve- K
operating temperature. hicle. A message prompting you to start the engine
L
b Vehicle has been driven at least at walking pace The engine will start automatically in certain situa- manually appears on the instrument cluster.
since the last Auto Stop. tions, e.g. to ensure passenger comfort via air con- > Please refer to chapter "Starting and Stopping M
Vehicles with PDK ditioning. The gearshift lever must be in neutral. In the Engine" on page 216.
some cases, a message prompting you to press the N
b Brake pedal pressed
b Operating mode D, M, N or P selected.
brake pedal will be displayed on the instrument Vehicles with PDK: Auto Stop and O
cluster.
b Driver’s seat belt fastened or driver’s door Auto Start P
closed.
Stopping the engine Q
Vehicles with manual transmission Reaction after leaving the vehicle
b Driver's door closed. If the driver's door is opened during an automatic 1. Brake the vehicle with the brake pedal. R
b Gear lever in neutral position and clutch pedal engine stop, the engine will not start automatically. 2. Keep the brake pedal pressed.
S
not pressed. An automatic engine start can still be performed by – or –
pressing the clutch pedal down fully. e Press the P button on the selector lever when the T
Auto Start Stop mode is resumed if one of the fol- vehicle is stationary.
U
lowing requirements is detected:
– The brake pedal is pressed, the driver's door is V
closed and the driver's seat belt is fastened. W
– or –
X
Y
Z
1. Equipment may be available for use only at a later time or may only be available in certain markets.
49
Auto Start Stop function
51
Battery
52
Battery
Danger of explosion Lead battery care Charging the lead battery A
While the battery is being charged, a
highly explosive gas mixture is formed, B
therefore: Information
C
Fire, sparks, naked flames and smoking Keep the battery fully charged to prevent it from
are prohibited freezing. A discharged battery can freeze even at D
Avoid causing sparks and short circuits 0 °C but a fully charged one only freezes at –40 °C. E
when handling cables and electrical de-
vices. In the case of batteries with cen- F
tral venting, there is a greater
What do I What do I have to do? G
concentration of explosive gas at the
want to do?
hose opening. The gas-venting hose H
must not be kinked or blocked with dirt. Avoid run- e Switch off unneeded electri- I
Danger of caustic burns ning down cal loads on short trips.
Battery acid is highly caustic, so: Wear the battery e Switch off the ignition when J
safety gloves and eye protection. Do not leaving the vehicle. K
tilt the battery, or acid may escape from e Avoid using the PCM when
the venting aperture. the engine is not running. L
First aid
M
If electrolyte fluid splashes into your eye, Battery care e Keep battery surface clean Fig. 22: Lead battery terminals
rinse immediately for a few minutes with and dry. N
+ Positive terminal
clean water. Immediately seek medical e Make sure that terminal
attention from a doctor. If acid splashes - Ground point O
clamps are firmly secured.
onto your skin or clothing, neutralise im- Charging a frozen or P
WARNING
mediately with soapsuds and rinse with Prepare for e Have the battery checked be- damaged battery
plenty of water. If you accidentally drink fore the start of winter. Q
winter
acid, consult a doctor immediately. If a frozen or damaged battery is charged, there is a
driving R
Disposal danger of explosion and chemical burns.
Hand in the old battery at a battery col- Charge the e Never attempt to charge a e Never attempt to charge a frozen or damaged
S
lection point. battery frozen or damaged battery. battery. T
Never dispose of an old battery with do-
mestic waste. e Observe the instructions of the charger U
manufacturer. V
e Ensure adequate ventilation when charging the
battery. W
1. Open the luggage compartment. X
> Please refer to chapter "Luggage Compart-
ment Lid" on page 149. Y
2. Remove cover in luggage compartment. Z
53
Battery
A > Please refer to chapter "Luggage compart- > Please refer to chapter "Tyres and Wheels" NOTICE
ment" on page 146. on page 238.
B
3. Connect the red positive cable of the charger to 3. Store end positions on vehicles with a slide/tilt Risk of short circuit, fire and damage to the genera-
C the positive terminal for jump-lead starting +. roof. tor and electronic control units and components.
4. Connect the black negative cable of the charger > Please refer to chapter "Slide/Tilt Roof" on
D e The battery should only be removed and installed
onto the – ground point. page 206.
at a qualified specialist workshop. Porsche rec-
E 5. Switch on the charger.
ommends a Porsche partner as they have trained
F 6. After charging the battery, first switch off the Lithium battery workshop personnel and the necessary parts and
charger and then disconnect it.
Electric shock, short cir- tools.
G e For recommendations on a suitable charger: WARNING
cuit, fire or explosion
H Contact your Porsche partner.
Touching conductive parts of the vehicle can give
I Replacing the lead battery you an electric shock. You can cause a short circuit
J The details on the battery case cannot be used to when working on the vehicle's electrical system.
identify a comparable battery that meets all the Short circuits can cause fires. Many automotive flu-
K specific requirements of Porsche. ids are highly flammable, e.g. fuel, engine or trans-
L e Always have the battery replaced by a qualified mission oil. Fuel vapours can combust.
specialist workshop.
e The battery should only be removed and installed
M e Only replace the lead battery with an AGM (Ab-
at a qualified specialist workshop. Porsche rec-
N sorbent Glass Mat) battery that meets the spe-
ommends a Porsche partner as they have trained
cific requirements of the vehicle. Porsche
O workshop personnel and the necessary parts and
recommends that you use a genuine Porsche
tools.
P battery.
e A new battery must be registered in the control Escaping electrolyte fluid
Q unit after installation. Visit a qualified specialist WARNING
and toxic gases
workshop. Porsche recommends a Porsche part-
R
ner as they have trained workshop personnel and Risk of electrolyte fluid and toxic gases escaping in
S the necessary parts and tools. exceptional cases if the battery is damaged or Fig. 23: Lithium battery
T e Observe the disposal instructions for batteries. handled incorrectly. The 12-volt lithium battery is located under the
U e Avoid any inhalation of the vapours and any skin plastic cover in the luggage compartment. For in-
Power interruption formation on removing the plastic cover:
contact with the electrolyte fluid.
V Following a temporary power interruption, some
e Keep people away and stay on the side facing > Please refer to chapter "Luggage compartment"
equipment has to be reinitialised. on page 146.
W into the wind.
1. Store the end position for the power windows. e Only charge lithium batteries in well-ventilated The 12-volt lithium battery is automatically discon-
X > Please refer to chapter "Windows" on rooms. nected from the vehicle electrical system if the bat-
page 273. tery charge condition is low. The electrical system is
Y 2. Teach in wheels and tyres in Tyre Pressure Mon- deactivated temporarily. When the battery is
Z itoring (TPM). charged (for at least 10 minutes) or when jump-lead
54
Battery
Never dispose of an old battery with do-
starting or connection to an external power supply What do I What do I have to do? A
take place, the electrical system is automatically re- mestic waste.
want to do? B
activated. The 12-volt lithium battery is automati- Always have maintenance work carried
cally reconnected to the vehicle electrical system. out by qualified technicians Charge the e Never charge a damaged C
> Please refer to chapter "Jump-lead Starting" on Never attempt to replace the battery
battery battery.
page 129. yourself. Only have the lithium battery of D
e Never connect jump leads directly to the battery.
this vehicle replaced with a lithium bat-
Lay up the e If the vehicle is left for long E
tery explicitly intended by Porsche for periods in the garage or
vehicle
Safety symbols on the lithium battery this vehicle. The use of other lithium or workshop, the doors and lids F
lead-acid batteries results in significant of the vehicle should be
Read instructions malfunctions including total failure of
G
closed.
the electrical system. H
Wear eye protection e Switch off ignition.
Always have the battery replaced by a
qualified specialist workshop. Porsche I
Danger of explosion recommends a Porsche partner as they J
Information
have trained workshop personnel and the
Fire, sparks, naked flames and smoking necessary parts and tools. The battery still discharges even while your vehicle K
are prohibited is not in use. L
Avoid causing sparks and short circuits Lithium battery care e To maintain its function, charge the battery ap-
when handling cables and electrical proximately every 6 weeks or connect it to a M
devices. trickle charger suitable for lithium batteries with
Danger of caustic burns
What do I What do I have to do? N
want to do? CC/CV or pure CV characteristic. Porsche rec-
Electrolyte fluid is highly corrosive: wear ommends Porsche Tequipment chargers and O
safety gloves and eye protection. Avoid run- e Switch off unneeded electri- trickle chargers. P
First aid ning down cal loads on short trips.
If electrolyte fluid splashes into your eye,
the battery e Switch off the ignition when Q
rinse immediately for a few minutes with leaving the vehicle.
clean water. Immediately seek medical R
attention from a doctor. If electrolyte Prepare for e Have the battery checked be- S
fluid splashes onto your skin or clothing, fore the start of winter.
winter T
neutralise immediately with soapsuds
driving
and rinse with plenty of water. If you ac- U
cidentally drink electrolyte fluid, consult
a doctor immediately. V
Keep children away W
Disposal X
Hand in the old battery at a battery col- Y
lection point.
Z
55
Battery
A Charging the lithium battery – Max. charging voltage: 14.8 V (even in the by Porsche for this vehicle. The use of other lith-
event of a fault with battery disconnected; no ium or lead-acid batteries results in significant
B voltage peaks permitted) malfunctions including total failure of the elec-
C – Max. charging current: 90 A trical system.
e If in doubt, contact your Porsche partner. e Always have the battery replaced by a qualified
D
specialist workshop. Porsche recommends a
E e Observe the instructions of the charger Porsche partner as they have trained workshop
manufacturer. personnel and the necessary parts and tools.
F
e Ensure adequate ventilation when charging the e Observe the disposal instructions for lithium
G battery. batteries.
H 1. Open the luggage compartment.
> Please refer to chapter "Luggage compart-
I Power interruption
ment" on page 146.
2. Fold open the cap on the positive terminal for Following a temporary power interruption, some
J equipment has to be reinitialised.
jump-lead starting +.
K 3. Connect the red positive cable of the charger to 1. Store the end position for the power windows.
the positive terminal for jump-lead starting +. > Please refer to chapter "Windows" on
L page 273.
4. Connect the black negative cable of the charger
M to the ground point –. 2. Teaching in wheels and tyres in Tyre Pressure
Fig. 24: Lithium battery terminals Monitoring (TPM).
N 5. Switch on the charger.
Escaping irritating gases > Please refer to chapter "Tyres and Wheels"
CAUTION 6. After charging the battery, first switch off the
O due to a damaged charger and then disconnect it. on page 238.
battery
P 7. Close the cap on the positive terminal for jump-
The use of non-approved chargers or boosters can lead starting +.
Q
result in the battery being charged with too high For recommendations on a suitable charger:
R charging voltage and too high charging current. This e Contact your Porsche partner.
S can damage the battery and irritating gases can es-
cape. This can cause considerable damage to the Replacing the lithium battery
T vehicle and burns. Danger of fire due to un-
WARNING
U e Only use chargers or boosters that have been suitable lithium battery
approved by the equipment manufacturer for
V In addition to significant malfunctions of the vehicle
LiFePO4 batteries with integrated electronic
W electrical system, use of an unsuitable lithium bat-
protection circuits.
tery or its incorrect installation may, in exceptional
e The following maximum values must never be
X cases cause a fire (e.g. during charging).
exceeded:
Y e Never attempt to replace the battery yourself.
Only have the lithium battery of this vehicle re-
Z placed with a lithium battery explicitly intended
56
Brake Fluid
57
Brakes
58
Brakes
Footbrake delayed and increased foot pressure may be of use and therefore cannot be expressed in actual A
Blocked pedals required. miles on the road.
WARNING B
e Check the brakes after washing the vehicle. The high performance brake system is designed to
e For this reason, keep further back from the ve- ensure the best possible braking effect at all speeds C
Unsuitable or improperly secured floor mats can re- and temperatures.
hicle in front and “dry” the brakes by applying D
strict pedal travel or interfere with pedal operation. Certain speeds, braking forces and ambient condi-
them at intervals. Make sure that the traffic be-
The accelerator pedal may be inadvertently actuated tions (e.g. temperature and humidity) can therefore E
hind you is not affected.
or the brake pedal blocked. This can result in an un- cause the brakes to squeal.
expected increase in speed or make braking more F
Reduced braking action
difficult. WARNING Responding to warning message G
e Only use floor mats that are suitable for the If the wear limit of the brake pads is reached, a
After a long drive over salted or gritted roads, a H
vehicle. warning symbol is displayed.
e Secure floor mats properly and do not place them coating may form on the brake discs and pads that > Please refer to chapter "Warning and Information I
loosely on the floor. significantly reduces friction and therefore the brak- Messages" on page 255.
J
e Do not lay several floor mats on top of each ing effect as well. e Have brake pads replaced immediately.
other. The brake discs will unavoidably start to corrode if Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Porsche K
e Ensure that the floor mats are securely fitted your vehicle is parked for an extended period. The recommends a Porsche partner as they have
brakes will tend to "judder" as a result. trained workshop personnel and the necessary L
again after they have been removed, such as for
cleaning. e If braking comfort is noticeably impaired: parts and tools. M
Go to a qualified specialist workshop. Porsche rec-
Porsche Ceramic Composite Brake (PCCB) N
No brake force boosting ommends a Porsche partner as they have trained
WARNING
workshop personnel and the necessary parts and The high performance brake system is designed to O
tools. ensure the best possible braking effect at all speeds
The brake booster is ready for operation only while and temperatures. P
the engine is running. For this reason, much greater e To relieve the brake system on steep slopes, re- Certain speeds, braking forces and ambient condi- Q
force has to be applied to the pedal when braking member to shift to a lower gear in good time tions (e.g. temperature and humidity) can therefore
while the engine is switched off or if there is a defect (engine braking effect). If the engine braking ef- cause the brakes to squeal. R
in the brake booster. fect on slopes is not sufficient, use the footbrake Wear on different components of the brake system, S
e Vehicles with defective brakes must not be at intervals. Continuous braking can cause the e.g. brake pads or brake discs, depends to a great
towed. brakes to overheat, impairing their effectiveness. extent on the individual driving style and the condi-
T
For information on brake fluid and checking the tions of use and therefore cannot be expressed in U
Water film on brake brake fluid level: actual miles on the road.
WARNING
discs > Please refer to chapter "Brake Fluid" on page 57. The values communicated by Porsche are based on
V
> Please refer to chapter "Towing" on page 228. normal operation adapted to the traffic situation. W
In heavy rain, when driving through water or after
Wear increases considerably when the vehicle is
leaving a car wash, the braking action may be Brake pads and brake discs X
driven on race tracks or as a result of aggressive
Wear on the brake pads and brake discs depends to driving. Y
a great extent on the driving style and the conditions
Z
59
Brakes
60
Car Care
61
Car Care
A vehicle. Risk What do you need to e Do not wash the convertible top every time you
B e Please consult the car wash operator before us- remember? wash the vehicle. Normally, rinsing the converti-
ing automatic car washes. ble top with clean water is sufficient.
C e Retract all spoilers before using automatic car Damage to wheels e Check the dimen- e Never remove snow and ice with sharp-edged
washes. sions of the car objects.
D wash guide rail. e Brush dust off the convertible top in the direction
E The wider the rim of the weave using a soft brush.
Risk What do you need to and the lower the e Only if there is heavy dirt, moisten the converti-
F tyre height, the
remember? ble top with lukewarm water and a washing
G greater the risk of shampoo & convertible-top cleaner and rub
Damage to the con- e No hot wax damage. gently using a sponge or soft brush.
H
vertible-top material treatment. e Rinse the washing shampoo & convertible-top
Scratches on high- e Do not clean with
I (Cabriolet) cleaner thoroughly off the convertible top with
gloss or silk-gloss the wheel-cleaning
clean water.
J Water gets into the e Do not switch off wheels brushes in the car
Porsche recommends car care products from
passenger compart- the ignition. wash.
K Porsche Tequipment.
ment through a low- – or – e After washing, treat the convertible-top covering
L ered window Lock the vehicle. Cleaning the convertible top at least once a year with a convertible-top care
M (Cabriolet) product. Do not allow the convertible-top care
(Cabriolet) product to come into contact with paint or glass.
N Windscreen wipers e Switch windscreen If it does come into contact with paint, remove it
wipers off. NOTICE
O can start moving and immediately.
become damaged in e Do not operate e If there is leakage in the convertible-top cover or
P the car wash. headlight cleaning The convertible top may be damaged by the cleaning at its seams and folds, a special convertible-top
system in car jet of the high-pressure cleaner, unsuitable car care product can be used. Please note the infor-
Q
washes. washes or by the hot wax treatment. mation on the containers.
R e Do not clean the convertible top with high-pres- Porsche recommends car care products from
Damage to external e Fold in exterior sure cleaning equipment. Porsche Tequipment.
S mirrors.
parts e Use car washes with a wash programme for e Remove bird excrement immediately. The acid
T e Remove roof trans- cabriolet vehicles. this contains makes the rubber swell, and the
e No hot wax treatment.
port system convertible top will start to leak.
U completely.
e Open the convertible top and convertible-top el-
V e Lock the vehicle. To ensure proper cleaning and care of your vehicle, ement only when completely dry to prevent
please observe the following: stains and abrasion damage.
W
e Remove spots from the convertible-top covering
X by rubbing carefully with a soft rubber sponge.
Y
Z
62
Car Care
Caring for paintwork corrosion begins. Visit a qualified specialist work- trained workshop personnel and the necessary A
shop. Porsche recommends a Porsche partner as parts and tools.
NOTICE they have trained workshop personnel and the nec- B
To ensure proper cleaning of your vehicle, please
essary parts and tools. observe the following: C
Dust particles on painted surfaces can damage the If traces of corrosion have already formed, these e Clean all windows regularly, inside and out, using
must be thoroughly removed. An anti-corrosion pri-
D
paintwork if not properly dealt with. a window cleaning agent.
e Do not rub dust with a dry cloth. mer must then be applied to these spots, followed e Do not dry the windows with the same chamois E
by top-coat paint. leather you use for the painted surface. Residue
F
from preservatives could impair visibility.
NOTICE
Caring for wiper blades e Remove insect residues with insect remover. G
The matt effect of bodywork sections may be lost if H
not looked after properly.
NOTICE Repairing the underbody
I
e Do not use preservatives or polishes on compo- The graphite coating on the wiper blades can be
protection
J
nents with a matt effect paint finish. damaged if they are not cleaned properly. Combustible materials
WARNING
e Ensure that the cleaning jet does not hit the close to the exhaust K
wiper blades. system
Preserving paintwork L
e Do not clean wiper blades with a cloth or sponge.
The paint surface will dull over time due to weath- Additional rust protection agent or undersealing in M
ering and should therefore be regularly protected e Clean wiper blades with clear water only.
the area of the exhaust system can become too hot
with a paint preservative after washing the vehicle. when driving and catch fire. N
Windscreen wiper blades that are in perfect condi-
This keeps the paint shiny and elastic, and prevents tion are vital for a clear view. e Do not apply additional underbody protection or O
dirt from adhering to the paint surface and industrial
e Clean the windscreen with window cleaner at rust protection agent on or near the exhaust
dust from penetrating the paint. P
regular intervals, especially after washing the manifolds, exhaust pipes, catalytic converters or
vehicle in a car wash. heat shields. Q
Polishing paintwork
e If extremely dirty (e.g. due to insect residues),
Paint polish should only be used to clean the paint- clean the windscreen using a sponge or cloth. The vehicle underbody is lastingly protected against R
work when the original shine can no longer be ob- chemical and mechanical effects. Damage to the S
The wiper blades should be replaced twice a year
tained using preservatives. protective coating while driving cannot be ruled out.
(before and after the cold season) or if wiper per-
formance deteriorates or the blades are damaged. e Porsche recommends that you have the vehicle T
Removing marks inspected at regular intervals by an qualified U
Remove tar spatters, traces of oil, insects, etc. as specialist workshop and the protective coating
soon as possible using an insect remover and wash
Cleaning windows restored as necessary. Contact your Porsche V
the area carefully afterwards as they discolour the The front side windows have a water-repellent (hy- partner.
drophobic) coating, which reduces soiling of the
W
paint if left to work on it over time.
windows. This coating is subject to natural wear and X
Repairing minor paint damage can be renewed.
e Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Porsche
Y
Have minor paint damage (cracks, scratches or
stone damage) repaired immediately before recommends a Porsche partner as they have Z
63
Car Care
A Cleaning decorative films Cleaning headlights, lights, plastic Metal particles (e.g. brass or copper in brake dust)
B components and surfaces, sen- must not remain too long on alloy wheels. Contact
NOTICE corrosion can cause pitting.
C sors and cameras Cleaners with an oxide-removing effect or wrong pH
Risk of damage through detachment of the decora- NOTICE value, as are commonly used for other metals, as
D well as mechanical tools and products, will damage
tive films during cleaning.
E e Do not use polish or hot wax. Cleaning agents can seep into the controls or
the surface and are therefore unsuitable.
e Do not use high-pressure cleaning equipment or e Use only acid-free cleaners for alloy wheels (pH
F switches, for example, and damage them. Unsuitable
value between 4 and 10). Products with the
steam cleaners. cleaning agents can damage the plastic surfaces.
G e Use a soft sponge, pH-neutral soap and plenty of e Do not spray water and interior window cleaner
wrong pH value can destroy the surface of the
wheels.
H water. directly onto the plastic components in the pas- e If possible, wash the wheels every two weeks
I senger compartment. with a sponge or washing brush. If the wheels are
e Only use clean water and a little washing-up
J Care instructions for protective liquid or interior window cleaner to clean head-
exposed to road salt, grit or industrial dust,
weekly cleaning is necessary.
K
films lights, lights, plastic components and surfaces,
L NOTICE
radar sensors for adaptive cruise control and ve- Cleaning door, roof, lid and win-
hicle cameras. Use a soft sponge or a soft, lint-
free cloth to do this. dow seals
M Risk of damage due to incorrect care of protective e Only clean the centre console with touch-sensi- NOTICE
N films. tive buttons using a microfibre cloth.
e Follow the care instructions provided by the e Never use other chemical cleaners or solvents.
O Unsuitable cleaning and care products can damage
protective film manufacturer.
P e After applying the film, wait at least 48 hours the lubricant coating on the inner door seals.
before washing the vehicle. Care of wheels e Do not use any chemical cleaning agents or
Q
e Do not wash the vehicle in a car wash. Cleaning agent film on
solvents.
R e Do not aim high-pressure cleaning equipment WARNING e Do not use any preservative agents.
brake discs
directly at the edges of the films.
S To ensure proper cleaning of your vehicle, please
e Remove dirt, e.g. insects, as quickly as possible. If cleaning agent (e.g. wheel cleaning agents) comes
observe the following:
T e Remove stubborn dirt using a 99 percent iso- into contact with the brake discs, the film that forms
on the brake discs may impair braking performance. e Wash dirt (e.g. abrasion, dust, road salt and grit)
U propanol solution.
from all seals regularly using warm soapy water.
e Apply hot wax evenly and make sure it is smooth e Make sure that no cleaning agent comes into
V e If there is a risk of frost, protect the outer door
and consistent. contact with the brake discs.
seals and the lid and flap seals from freezing us-
W e If cleaning agent has come into contact with the ing a suitable care product.
brake discs, clean the brake discs thoroughly
X with a strong jet of water.
Y e Paying attention to any road users behind you,
dry the brake discs by applying the brakes.
Z
64
Car Care
Caring for leather Make sure that the perforated leather does not To protect carpets, the Porsche range of accessories A
get wet on its reverse side. includes floor mats in the correct size and with the
NOTICE appropriate fastening. B
2. Allow the seat cover to dry completely at room
temperature out of direct sunlight. Do not switch C
The leather may become damaged by the use of on seat heating and seat ventilation. Cleaning airbag covers D
unsuitable cleaning agents and care products, and 3. Once dry, wipe the seat cover with a dry, lint-free
Improper cleaning
by inappropriate treatment. cloth. DANGER E
e Do not use aggressive cleaners or hard cleaning F
objects. Cleaning carpet, floor mats Unsuitable cleaning and care agents can penetrate
e Ensure that perforated leather does not get wet Blocked pedals
into the airbag system. Improper handling can dam- G
on the reverse side. WARNING age the airbag system. In the event of an accident, H
e Remove water drops from the leather the airbag systems may not be triggered.
immediately. Unsuitable or improperly secured floor mats can re- e Do not make any adjustments to individual com-
I
strict pedal travel or interfere with pedal operation. ponents such as the steering wheel covers, the J
To ensure proper cleaning and care of your vehicle, The accelerator pedal may be inadvertently actuated dashboard, the front seats and the door and
please observe the following: or the brake pedal blocked. This can result in an un- ceiling panels.
K
e Clean all types of leather regularly to remove fine expected increase in speed or make braking more e Do not use cleaning agents or other liquids in the L
dust using a soft, damp, white woollen cloth or a difficult. area of the airbags.
commercially available microfibre cloth. M
e Only use floor mats that are suitable for the
e Remove heavy soiling (not water or moisture
vehicle. N
stains) with a leather cleaning agent. Read the
e Secure floor mats properly and do not place them Cleaning fabric linings
instructions for use on the containers. O
Porsche recommends car care products from loosely on the floor. Fabric linings on pillars, roofliner, and sun blinds, etc.
Porsche Tequipment. e Do not lay several floor mats on top of each must only be cleaned using suitable cleaning agents, P
suitable dry foam and a soft brush.
e Treat cleaned leather only with a leather care other.
Q
product. e Ensure that the floor mats are securely fitted
again after they have been removed, such as for Alcantara®/Race-Tex care R
Cleaning seats with seat ventilation cleaning. Do not use leather care products to clean microfibre S
Stains resulting from rainwater or moisture may oc- covers made of Alcantara®/Race-Tex. For regular
To ensure proper cleaning of your vehicle, please T
cur on the perforated leather of the seats. observe the following: care, it is sufficient to clean the cover with a soft
brush. Strong abrasion or rubbing when cleaning will
Removing water and moisture stains e Clean using a vacuum cleaner or a brush that is U
create a lasting change to the surface.
b Seat heating and seat ventilation is switched off. not too soft.
e When lightly soiled, dampen a soft cloth with V
b No direct sunlight. e Remove heavy dirt and stains using a stain
water or a pH-neutral soap solution and wipe off W
1. Dab the entire seat and backrest surface using a remover.
the dirt.
Porsche recommends car care products from X
clean, fine-pored sponge and distilled water. e When heavily soiled, dampen a soft cloth with
Porsche Tequipment.
lukewarm water or thinned white spirit and dab Y
off the dirt from the outside in.
Z
65
Car Care
66
Central locking
Central locking A
B
Brief overview – opening and
C
locking doors from outside
D
This brief overview does not replace the complete
E
information provided under "Central locking system".
Safety messages and warnings, in particular, are not F
replaced by this brief overview.
G
H
I
J
K
Fig. 27: Driver’s key Fig. 28: Comfort Access
L
What do I want to do? What do I have to do? What happens? Where? M
Unlock With driver's key: The hazard warning lights flash once. > p. 69 N
e Press the button on the driver’s The door handles extend. O
key. The doors can be opened. P
With Comfort Access:
e Grasp into the handle recess of
Q
the door handle. R
Lock With driver's key: The hazard warning lights flash twice. > p. 70 S
e Press the button on the driver’s The door handles retract. T
key. The doors are locked and cannot be U
With Comfort Access: opened from inside by pulling the
e Touch proximity sensor A on the door opener (SAFELOCK). The alarm V
door handle. system is triggered in the event of an W
attempt to open from the inside.
X
Y
Z
67
Central locking
Unlocking doors The vehicle unlocks depending on the setting The vehicle unlocks depending on the setting A
and the door handle extends. and the door handle extends.
B
Information 2. Pull the door handle. 2. Pull the door handle.
C
If the vehicle is unlocked and if a door or the rear lid Unlocking doors with proximity sensor in door Information
is not opened within 12 seconds, the vehicle is handle D
locked again automatically. To save the battery, unnecessary comfort functions E
are progressively switched off. The vehicle can then
be unlocked using the driver's key. F
Information
G
In the event of an accident in which the airbag is
Unlocking the doors on approaching the H
triggered, the entire vehicle is unlocked automati-
vehicle
cally in order to enable helpers gain access to the I
vehicle. The hazard warning lights are also activated b Vehicles with Comfort Access.
automatically. b Function activated. J
b Carry the driver's key with you, e.g. in your trou- K
ser pocket.
Unlocking the doors with the driver's key The central locking can be configured such that the L
doors are automatically unlocked when you ap- M
proach the vehicle (from a distance of approx. 2 m).
The prerequisite for this is that the driver's key was N
at least approx. 6 m away from the vehicle after the O
last locking operation.
1. Approach the vehicle. P
Fig. 30: Unlocking door with Comfort Access
The hazard warning lights flash once. Q
b Vehicles with Comfort Access The vehicle unlocks depending on the setting
b Function activated. and the door handle extends. R
> Please refer to chapter "Vehicle Settings" on 2. Grasp into the handle recess of the door handle. S
page 246. Do not touch the proximity sensor on the front of
T
b Carry the driver's key with you, e.g. in your trou- the door handle in the process.
ser pocket. 3. Pull the door handle. U
b The doors can be unlocked on the side of the
V
vehicle where the driver’s key is located.
1. Grasp into the handle recess of the door handle. W
Do not touch the proximity sensor on the front of
X
Fig. 29: Unlocking the doors with the driver's key
the door handle in the process.
The hazard warning lights flash once. Y
1. Press button .
Z
The hazard warning lights flash once.
69
Central locking
70
Central locking
Information The hazard warning lights flash twice. Locking doors from inside A
The door handles retract.
If the key is inside the vehicle when you lock it, the B
vehicle is unlocked again. Several warning tones Deactivating SAFELOCK when the vehicle is locked
C
sound and the vehicle flashes 4 times. The vehicle is e Touch proximity sensor A on the door handle
only locked if no door or the rear lid is opened within twice within 2 seconds. D
approx. 45 seconds and can only be unlocked using a The hazard warning lights flash slowly once.
E
second key. The door handles retract.
e Make sure that the driver’s key is not left inside The doors are locked, but can be opened from F
the vehicle when locking it. inside by pulling the door opener. G
e Inform any persons remaining in the vehicle that
the alarm system will be triggered if the door is H
Locking doors with proximity sensor in door
opened. I
handle
Information J
K
– The vehicle cannot be completely locked if the
doors or rear lid are not fully closed. A warning L
tone sounds and the hazard warning lights do not
flash.
M
Fig. 33: Central locking button in the door panel
– The driver's key must be outside the vehicle N
b Doors closed.
when locking the vehicle doors, otherwise the
vehicle doors cannot be locked. e Press button in the door panel. O
All doors are locked. The filler flap is not locked. P
The door handles retract.
The indicator light on the button comes on.
Q
The doors can only be opened from inside by R
pulling the door opener.
S
Automatic locking (Auto Lock) T
b Function activated.
U
Fig. 32: Locking doors with Comfort Access The vehicle is locked automatically from a speed of
V
b Vehicles with Comfort Access
approx. 9 mph (15 km/h).
> Please refer to chapter "Vehicle Settings" on
b Operating mode P selected. W
page 246.
b Carry the driver's key with you, e.g. in your trou- X
ser pocket.
b All doors are closed. Y
e Touch proximity sensor A on the door handle. Z
71
Central locking
A NOTICE 1. Remove the emergency key from the driver's key. clockwise until you feel initial resistance and
> Please refer to chapter "Using the emergency then firmly turn it further as far as it will go.
B
Extended door handles can be damaged in car key" on page 97. 5. Turn the emergency key back to its initial posi-
C washes. 2. Pull and hold the door handle. tion again and remove it.
3. Insert the emergency key with the round edge 6. Close the door.
D e Lock the vehicle before starting the car wash.
upwards into the door lock (right-hand drive: 7. Check that the vehicle is locked.
E with the round edge facing downwards). 8. For emergency locking of the passenger's door,
F Emergency unlocking and emer- 4. Turn the emergency key anti-clockwise until you insert the emergency key in the door lock of the
feel initial resistance and then firmly turn it fur- driver's door again, turn it 90° against the direc-
G gency locking of doors ther as far as it will go. tion of travel and remove the emergency key
5. Turn the emergency key back to its initial posi- again. The passenger's door is locked.
H
tion again and remove it.
I 6. Switch on the ignition within 15 seconds in order Information
J to prevent triggering of the alarm system.
In the event of a central locking fault, all functional
K locks in the central locking system can be locked via
Information the lock in the driver's door.
L e Have faults in the central locking system
The time it takes to trigger the alarm system differs
M depending on the country. repaired.
e Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Porsche
N recommends a Porsche partner as they have
O Performing emergency door locking trained workshop personnel and the necessary
parts and tools.
P
Information
Q
Only emergency lock the doors when the engine has
R been switched off.
S e Unlock the doors before starting to drive.
Fig. 34: Emergency unlocking/emergency locking
T 1. Remove the emergency key from the driver's key.
If the driver's key remote control does not work, the
U doors can also be unlocked and locked without the > Please refer to chapter "Using the emergency
remote control. key" on page 97.
V 2. Pull and hold the door handle.
W Performing emergency door unlocking 3. Insert the emergency key with the round edge
e Hold the driver's key at the centre of the wind- upwards into the door lock (right-hand drive:
X with the round edge facing downwards).
screen at the top and press the button at the
Y 4. With the door open, turn the emergency key
same time.
Z If the vehicle still cannot be unlocked:
72
Child Restraint Systems (Child Seats)
by Porsche. These restraint systems have been e Never remove, deface or render illegible airbag M
tested and adjusted to suit the interior of Por- warning stickers A or warning signs.
N
sche vehicles and the appropriate child weight
classes. Other systems have not been tested and Using child restraint systems correctly O
could increase the risk of injury. 1. Use a child restraint system of the correct
P
e Switch off the passenger airbag if a child re- weight and size category.
straint system is installed on the passenger's > Please refer to chapter "Using child restraint Q
seat. systems of the correct weight and size class"
Fig. 35: Airbag warning sticker on page 74. R
Porsche recommends Porsche Tequipment child re- 2. Use the correct fitting position for child restraint S
straint systems. For information on installation systems.
T
options: > Please refer to chapter "Use the correct fit-
e Contact your Porsche partner. ting position for child restraint systems" on U
> Please refer to chapter "Use the correct fitting page 76.
position for child restraint systems" on page 76. V
3. Install the child restraint system securely.
Child restraint system on > Please refer to chapter "Installing child re- W
DANGER straint systems" on page 78.
passenger’s seat X
The passenger airbag offers protection only for per- Y
sons of a certain minimum size and minimum
Z
weight. If a child restraint system is fitted on the
73
Child Restraint Systems (Child Seats)
A Using child restraint systems of Children in this group are carried in child restraint E ISO/R1: rear-facing, child restraint system for
infants
B the correct weight and size class systems facing backward.
F ISO/L1: left side-facing child restraint system
e In addition the suitable weight and size class, al- (baby carrier)
C so check the correct installation position.
Children in group I: 9 to 18 kg
G ISO/L2: right side-facing child restraint system
(secured with ISOFIX system or vehicle seat belt)
D > Please refer to chapter "Use the correct fitting (baby carrier)
Children in this group must be carried in child re-
position for child restraint systems" on page 76.
E straint systems facing forward. In exceptional cases, e Observe the scope of application of the child re-
children in this weight group can also be carried in straint system as well as the manufacturer's in-
F special child restraint systems that are facing back- stallation and operating instructions for the child
G ward. Whenever possible, these child restraint sys- restraint system being used.
tems should be installed on the rear seats.
H Weight class Size category Child re-
I Children in group II: 15 to 25 kg straint
(secured with the vehicle seat belt) system
J Children in this group must be carried in child re-
K straint systems facing forward. Whenever possible, Group 0: 0 to F ISO/L1
these child restraint systems should be installed on 10 kg
L the rear seats. G ISO/L2
M E ISO/R1
Children in group III: 22 to 36 kg
N (secured with the vehicle seat belt) Group 0+: 0 C ISO/R3
O Children in this group must be carried in child re- to 13 kg
straint systems facing forward. Whenever possible, D ISO/R2
P these child restraint systems should be installed on
Q Fig. 37: Example of ECE child restraint system sticker the rear seats. E ISO/R1
A Size category
R B "Universal" or "semi universal" marking Classification of child restraint systems by Group I: 9 to A ISO/F3
C Weight class size classes 18 kg
S B ISO/F2
T e In the case of child restraint systems with semi A ISO/F3: front-facing, full-height child restraint
universal approval, please refer to the vehicle system B1 ISO/F2X
U type list provided with the relevant child restraint B ISO/F2: front-facing, reduced-height child re-
system or available on the Internet. straint system C ISO/R3
V
B1 ISO/F2X: front-facing, reduced-height child
W Classification of child restraint systems into D ISO/R2
restraint system
X weight classes C ISO/R3: rear-facing, full-size child restraint
system
Y Children in group 0 and 0+: up to 13 kg D ISO/R2: rear-facing, reduced-size child re-
Z (secured with ISOFIX system and vehicle seat belt) straint system
74
Child Restraint Systems (Child Seats)
75
Child Restraint Systems (Child Seats)
76
Child Restraint Systems (Child Seats)
Largest suitable rear-facing child restraint system No R2 This seat is only suitable for child re-
F
straint systems recommended by G
Largest suitable forward-facing child restraint system No F3 Porsche.
H
> Please refer to
chapter "Recommended child re- I
straint systems" on page 75.
J
No: Seat is not suitable for installation of a child restraint system of this group. K
L
Overview of installation of child restraint X: Seat is not suitable for child restraint sys-
tems of this group.
M
systems on the passenger seat
U / L: Suitable for forward-facing child restraint N
When installing child restraint systems of the Uni-
versal (U) or "semi universal" (L) approval categories systems in the “Universal” or "semi univer-
sal" approval categories, which are secured O
on the passenger seat, check whether the passenger
airbag needs to be switched off using the table with the seat belt for adults and are ap- P
below. proved for use with this group.
Q
For information on the approval category, please re-
fer to the orange certification mark on the child re- R
straint system. S
Group Passenger airbag switched on Passenger airbag switched off T
U
Group 0: X U/L
0 to 10 kg V
W
Group 0+: X U/L
X
M
N
Installing child restraint systems 1. Open the glove box.
2. Remove the emergency key from the driver's key.
O Baby carriers > Please refer to chapter "Driver's Key" on
Left or right-facing child restraint systems from size page 97.
P
categories F and G (e.g. baby carriers) should not
Q generally be used on any of the seat versions. NOTICE
Porsche recommends Porsche Tequipment child re-
R straint systems (e.g. Porsche Babyseat ISOFIX G0+). Risk of damage to the key switch and airbag system
S e Only turn the emergency key if it is inserted as
Switching passenger airbag on and off far as it will go in the key switch.
T
Passenger airbag It must be possible to turn the key switch with-
U DANGER
switched off out exerting excessive force.
V e Only switch the passenger air bag on or off when
The passenger airbag will not be triggered in an ac-
the ignition is switched off.
W cident if it is switched off.
X e Only switch off the passenger airbag if a child
restraint systems is fitted on the passenger seat. Fig. 39: Switching off the passenger airbag
Y e Switch the passenger airbag back on once the
child restraint system has been removed. b Ignition switched off.
Z
78
Child Restraint Systems (Child Seats)
3. Insert the emergency key as far as it will go in the When the airbag on the passenger’s side is switched Installing child restraint system on rear seats with A
key switch. off, the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator is con- vehicle seat belt
B
4. Using the emergency key, switch the passenger tinuously lit when the ignition is switched on/the e Make sure that there is solid contact between
airbag off (switch position OFF) or on (switch engine is running. the rear seat and child restraint system. C
position ON). Passenger airbag switched on e In the case of booster seats without backrest,
D
Risk of serious or fatal ensure that the booster seat contacts the rear
DANGER When the passenger airbag is switched on, the
injury due to the passen- seat backrest. E
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator comes on for
ger airbag triggering approx. 1 minute when the ignition is switched on F
inadvertently. Installation of child restraint system with
and then goes out.
ISOFIX system G
If the emergency key is left in the key switch during DANGER
Failure or malfunction of > Please refer to chapter "Using child restraint H
driving, it may inadvertently turn in the key switch the passenger airbag systems of the correct weight and size class" on
due to vibration, possibly triggering the airbag. page 74. I
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator does not
e Never leave the emergency key in the key switch e Always refer to the separate installation instruc- J
light up when the ignition is switched on and the
when driving. tions for your child restraint system.
passenger airbag is switched off, there may be a
K
fault in the system. Installing child restraint system on the passenger
5. Remove the emergency key from the key switch.
6. Close the glove box. e Do not install a child restraint system on the seat L
passenger seat. M
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF/ON indicator e Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Porsche
recommends a Porsche partner as they have N
trained workshop personnel and the necessary O
parts and tools.
P
Q
Installing child restraint system with vehicle
seat belt R
Installing child restraint system on rear seats with S
vehicle seat belt
T
Fig. 40: PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF/ON indicator 1. Adjust the backrest angle of the passenger seat
so that there is solid contact between the pas- U
The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF/ON indicator is lo- senger seat and child restraint system.
cated on the overhead console. V
2. Adjust the passenger seat to the rearmost upper
Lamp check position. W
Once the ignition has been switched on, the PAS- > Please refer to chapter "Adjusting the seat"
X
SENGER AIR BAG OFF/ON indicator comes on for on page 203. Fig. 41: ISOFIX anchorage system on passenger seat
approx. 5 seconds for a lamp check. 3. Ensure a comfortable distance between the front Y
Passenger airbag switched off passenger seat and a passenger sitting behind it.
Z
79
Child Restraint Systems (Child Seats)
A The retaining lugs A of the ISOFIX child restraint Installing child restraint system with support leg on Installing child restraint system on the rear seats
system anchorage points are located between the passenger seat
B backrest and seat surface of the passenger seat.
C 1. Deactivate the passenger airbag with the emer-
gency key in the glove box OFF.
D
The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF warning light on
E the overhead console must come on.
2. Adjust the passenger seat to the rearmost upper
F
position.
G > Please refer to chapter "Adjusting the seat"
on page 203.
H
3. Secure the child restraint system to retaining
I lugs A as described in the instruction manual for
the child restraint system.
J
4. Pull the child restraint system to check that both
K anchorage points are properly engaged.
L 5. Adjust the backrest angle of the passenger seat
so that there is solid contact between the pas-
M senger seat and child restraint system.
Fig. 43: ISOFIX anchorage system on rear seats
N 6. If the rear seat is occupied, make sure that there
Fig. 42: Installing child restraint system with support leg
is sufficient clearance between the child or child The retaining lugs A of the ISOFIX anchorage system
O seat or passenger and the front seat. Adjust the 1. Install the child restraint system with ISOFIX an- for the child restraint system are located behind the
front seat in front of the child or child seat or chorage system correctly with the retaining lug backrest lower sections.
P
passenger as far forward and as high as possible, A. 1. First detach the backrest lower section at the top
Q and the seat backrest as steeply as possible. > Please refer to chapter "ISOFIX anchorage centre (Velcro strap), disengage from the retain-
system on passenger seat" on page 79. ing lugs A and remove.
R 2. Secure the child restraint system to retaining
2. Position the support leg in accordance with the
S child restraint system manufacturer's lugs A as described in the instruction manual for
instructions. the child restraint system.
T
3. Ensure that the child restraint system is posi- 3. Pull the child restraint system to check that both
U tioned flush against the passenger seat. anchorage points are properly engaged.
4. Make sure that there is solid contact between
V
the rear seat and child restraint system.
W 5. Make sure that there is sufficient clearance be-
tween the child or child seat and the front seat.
X
Adjust the front seat in front of the child or child
Y seat as far forward and as high as possible, and
the seat backrest as steeply as possible.
Z
80
Child Restraint Systems (Child Seats)
81
Convertible top
A Convertible top Opening and closing the converti- Opening and closing the convertible top using
B > Please refer to chapter "Car Care" on page 61. ble top the button in the vehicle interior
> Please refer to chapter "Warning and Information
C Opening and closing the
Messages" on page 255. WARNING
convertible top
D
NOTICE
When opening and closing the convertible top, parts
E
of the body can become trapped between the con-
F Risk of damage to convertible top and convertible- vertible-top mechanism or convertible-top com-
top drive partment lid and fixed vehicle parts.
G e Do not operate convertible top: e Make sure that nobody is at risk of injury from
H – At temperatures below 0 °C. the convertible-top mechanism or the converti-
– When one side of the vehicle is on a kerb, a ble-top compartment lid.
I
lifting platform or a jack. e Do not operate the convertible top with the driv-
J – When items of luggage or other objects (for er's key if the vehicle is out of your sight.
K
example, behind the rear seats) hinder the e In order to interrupt convertible-top operation in
movement of the convertible top. the event of danger, immediately release the
L – With the roll-over bars extended. button in the vehicle or driver's key button.
M e Avoid frequent convertible top operation with e Keep the covers of the vanity mirrors in the sun
the engine off so that the vehicle battery does visors closed when closing the convertible top.
N not rapidly discharge. Fig. 45: Opening the convertible top with the button
O e Only drive with the convertible top fully open or The front and rear side windows are lowered auto-
matically when the convertible top is opened.
closed.
P e When opening or closing the convertible top,
The front side windows close automatically if oper-
ation of the convertible top is continued after it has
Q ensure that there is sufficient clearance above it
reached its end position.
(e.g. in the garage). The front and rear side windows are lowered auto-
R e To prevent damp stains and abrasion damage, matically when the convertible top is closed. They
S open the convertible top only when it is in a dry, close automatically if operation of the convertible
clean state. top is continued after it has reached its end position.
T
e Park the vehicle in the shade if possible, since
U continuous exposure to the sun attacks textiles,
rubber and paint.
V
e The convertible top may only be operated when
W driving on a level road surface.
e Do not operate the convertible top in strong
X
winds or storms.
Y
Z Fig. 46: Closing the convertible top with the button
82
Convertible top
83
Convertible top
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L Fig. 49: Removing the emergency operation key
O Fig. 48: Folding the rear seat backrests and rear-wall 1. Remove plastic attachment B from the emer-
lining forwards gency operation key A.
P 2. Swivel the metal insert approx. 90° upwards out
2. Fold the rear seat backrests forward
Q of the plastic attachment B and remove it by
3. Carefully lever out the rear-wall lining from the pulling forward.
R locking points using the screwdriver and fold
forwards
S – or –
T Depending on the equipment, pull out the rear-
wall lining at both straps and fold forwards.
U
V
W
X
Y
Z
84
Convertible top
85
Convertible top
86
Convertible top
87
Convertible top
M 4. Press both rear side flaps downwards until the 2. Remove plug O at the access point for converti-
end position is reached. Fig. 62: Pulling convertible top out of storage compartment ble-top lock emergency operation.
N
1. From the passenger compartment, pull the con-
O vertible top centrally out of the storage com-
partment until it is approximately half closed.
P
Risk of injury due to
Q CAUTION
crushing during closing
R
If body parts are located within the range of move-
S ment of the convertible top or in the area of the
T convertible top lock during closing, there is a risk of
pinching or crushing.
U e Pay attention to the following:
V – That no persons are within the range of
movement of the convertible top during
W closing.
X – Keep your hands away from the range of
movement of the convertible top during
Y closing.
Z Fig. 64: Extending the convertible top latching hook
88
Convertible top
3. Remove plastic attachment B from the emer- Closing the convertible-top compartment lid The convertible-top compartment lid is not A
gency operation key. locked.
Closing of the converti- B
4. Swivel metal insert A approx. 90° upwards out of WARNING 4. Hand-tighten emergency hand screw H in the
ble-top compartment lid
plastic attachment B and remove it by pulling passenger compartment clockwise. C
forwards. Parts of the body may become trapped between the D
5. Insert plastic attachment B into the access point convertible-top compartment lid and fixed vehicle
for convertible-top lock emergency operation parts when closing the convertible-top compart- E
and turn it to the left or right until it engages. ment lid. F
6. Turn plastic attachment B anti-clockwise until e Place your hands on top of the convertible-top
the latching hook is fully extended (noticeable compartment lid when pushing. G
resistance).
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
Fig. 66: Closing the convertible-top compartment lid
Fig. 65: Closing the convertible top T
7. Pull the convertible top to the windscreen frame. 1. Stand behind the vehicle:
2. Grasp the convertible-top compartment lid U
8. To fully close the convertible top, turn plastic
attachment B clockwise until the latching hook above the brake light and push forwards against V
fully engages in the catch (noticeable noticeable resistance until it is completely
closed. W
resistance).
3. Push the convertible-top compartment lid into X
the end position.
Y
Z
89
Coolant
90
Coolant
91
Cruise control (CC)
92
Cruise control (CC)
The options menu for the driver assistance sys- 1. Accelerate or decelerate to the desired speed e Press the control stalk downwards (position 4, A
tems appears on the instrument cluster. using the accelerator pedal. CANCEL).
– or – B
2. If cruise control is not already selected, select CC 2. Briefly press the control stalk forward (position
using the rotary push button on the steering 1) and release the accelerator pedal. e Press brake pedal C
wheel and press to confirm. Cruise control is active. – or – D
e Press the clutch pedal for longer than approx.
Cruise control is switched on and passive. The current driving speed appears green in the
The operating status appears grey in the status status display and is maintained automatically. 7 seconds (vehicles with manual transmission). E
display. There is no speed stored.
– or – F
Switching from an already activated driver assis- Changing the desired speed e Move selector lever to operating mode N (ve- G
tance system to cruise control The desired speed can be increased or decreased by hicles with PDK).
b Vehicles with button S on the control stalk. pressing the control stalk.
Cruise control is passive. The set value for the H
1. Press button S on the control stalk. b Cruise control active. desired speed remains stored. The status display I
The options menu for the driver assistance sys- Increasing the speed changes from green to grey.
J
tems appears on the instrument cluster. e Press the control stalk forward (position 1):
2. Select CC using the rotary push button on the – Brief press = 1 km/h (1 mph) increments Cruise control operation is interrupted auto- K
steering wheel and press to confirm. – Press and hold = 10 km/h (6 mph) matically in the following situations:
Cruise control is switched on and passive. increments – The vehicle speed is above or below the set L
The operating status appears grey in the status speed for a certain time. M
Reduce speed
display. There is no speed stored. – Porsche Stability Management (PSM) is active.
e Pull the control stalk (position 2): N
– Brief pull = 1 km/h (1 mph) increments
Information – Pull and hold = 10 km/h (6 mph) increments Resuming the stored speed – O
The last selected driver assistance system is re- The new desired speed is displayed on the instru- RESUME P
tained even after switching it off and operational ment cluster. e Press the control stalk upwards (position 3, Q
readiness is restored. RESUME).
Information Cruise control accelerates or brakes the vehicle R
Switching cruise control off The speed can be increased using the accelerator to the stored speed. S
e Press button R on the control stalk. pedal as usual. This does not change the stored val-
ue; it is resumed after the accelerator pedal is T
The memory is cleared and the readiness symbol
disappears. released. U
V
Activating cruise control
b Cruise control switched on.
Cancel cruise control operation – W
b Speed is higher than 30 km/h (20 mph). CANCEL X
Following deactivation, cruise control switches to
standby mode and remains in standby until it is ac- Y
tivated manually again. Z
93
Cupholders
A Cupholders Inserting the cupholder in the centre console Removing the cupholder from the centre
console
B
Using cupholders
C
Objects in the centre
D WARNING
console
E If the storage compartment or cupholder is not in-
F serted in the centre console, objects can block or
activate the parking brake button. This can lead to
G unwanted braking.
H e When storing objects in the centre console, al-
ways use the supplied storage compartment.
I
e Only use the cupholder for the storage of drinks
J as intended.
e Never store items in the cupholder.
K
e Never operate the vehicle without an inserted
L cupholder or inserted storage compartment.
M Spilled hot drinks
CAUTION Fig. 69: Inserting the cupholder in the centre console
N Fig. 70: Removing the cupholder from the centre console
e Insert the cupholder and press downwards until
O Hot drinks can cause scalding if spilt. it clicks into place. e Press the button and remove the cupholder
upwards.
P e Only use containers that fit. The cupholder can be used.
e Never put overfull containers in the cupholder. Depending on the vehicle equipment, an ashtray is
Q e Do not use for hot drinks. available, which can be inserted into the cupholder.
e The cupholder on the passenger must be kept > Please refer to chapter "Smoker's Package" on
R page 210.
closed during driving.
S
T NOTICE
U
Risk of damage from spilled drinks.
V
e Only use containers that fit.
W e Never put overfull containers in the cupholder.
X There is a cupholder in the centre console and one
Y below the outer air vent on the passenger side.
94
Cupholders
Using the cupholder on the passenger side e To open, press on the panel below the outer air A
vent on the passenger side.
B
The cupholder opens automatically.
e To close, insert the cupholder until it clicks into C
place.
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
Fig. 71: Cupholder
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
W
X
Y
Fig. 72: Opening cupholder
Z
95
Device Manager
A Device Manager Pairing a new device via mobile phone) to the PCM via WiFi and to use
B Bluetooth® a WiFi hotspot.
Opening the Device Manager – Connected WiFi devices: List of all WiFi de-
C 1. Select or in the footer (depending on vices which have been registered.
The Device Manager provides an overview of the
available devices and of their connection status. the connection status) e Search for new – Search for WiFi hotspot: Search for a new
D WiFi hotspot and enter access data of exter-
device.
E e Select or in the footer (depending on 2. Select the device from the list.
nal WiFi hotspot (user name and password).
the connection status). When entering the data, pay attention to
F A 6-digit Bluetooth® code is generated and dis- upper and lower case.
played in the PCM and on the device. – Mobile data:
G
Displaying connection status 3. Compare the Bluetooth® code in the PCM and – Switch mobile data on or off.
H on the device. – Share data connection: Enable data connec-
I Colours and meanings of the symbols tion for WiFi devices.
– Green symbol: Connection is active. 4. If the Bluetooth® code in the PCM and on the – Roaming: Allow or block data connections in
J device match, confirm. external networks.
– White symbol: Connection is possible, not yet
active. If the mobile phone has been successfully con- – Vehicle hotspot: Display PCM WiFi access data.
K nected, it appears in the device overview.
– No symbol: Connection is not possible. – Delete paired devices
L For information on operating Porsche
M Available functions Communication Management (PCM):
– Phone: Mobile phones connected via Blue- > Please refer to chapter "Porsche Communication
N Management (PCM)" on page 175.
tooth®. Please refer to chapter "Telephone" on
O page 222.
P – Music: External media sources connected via Device Manager settings
Bluetooth®. Please refer to chapter "Media" on
Q page 152. e Select or in the header (depending on
R – Data: Data connection established via the the connection status) e Options .
S access point. Please refer to chapter "Porsche – Telephone: Please refer to chapter "Telephone"
Connect" on page 182. on page 222.
T – App: Porsche Connect App connected by – Bluetooth:
U WiFi. Please refer to chapter "Apps" on page 41. – Switch Bluetooth on or off.
For further information on the Porsche Connect – Allow access to SIM card.
V App: Visit www.porsche.com/connect. – Edit Bluetooth name of PCM.
W – Link: iPhone connected via USB port with – WiFi:
access to Apple CarPlay. Please refer to chap- – Switch WiFi on or off.
X – Configure WiFi hotspot in PCM: Display and
ter "Apple CarPlay" on page 39.
Y configure PCM WiFi access data. This data is
required to be able to connect a device (e.g.
Z
96
Driver's Key
97
Driver's Key
A Replacing battery in driver's key Changing the battery (CR 2032, 3 V) Ordering and storing replacement
B Risk of internal burns or 1. Remove the emergency key. keys
WARNING 2. Unclip the two-part driver's key housing to the
death from swallowing Driver's keys can only be ordered from a Porsche
C the lithium coin cell right and left. partner. This can take a long time.
D (button battery) 3. Unscrew the battery cover anti-clockwise and e Always have a replacement key available.
remove.
e Keep the replacement key in a safe place, but
E The driver's key contains a lithium coin cell (battery). 4. Change the battery (checking polarity). under no circumstances in or on the vehicle.
F Swallowing the battery can cause internal burns 5. Re-fit the battery cover and screw it back on To teach new driver's keys for the vehicle:
firmly clockwise.
G
within two hours and this can result in death. e Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Porsche
e Keep removed or new batteries out of children's Ensure that the emergency key can be pushed in. recommends a Porsche partner as they have
H reach. 6. Push the driver’s key housing upwards from be- trained workshop personnel and the necessary
I e Keep driver's keys out of children's reach. Chil- low and clip into place. parts and tools.
dren could open the driver's key and remove the 7. Insert the emergency key. e Teach all driver's keys belonging to the vehicle
J battery. again.
K e If the battery is swallowed or inserted into a body Starting vehicle when driver’s key
L
orifice, seek medical attention from a doctor battery is flat or there is radio Information
immediately.
interference A total of eight driver's keys can be taught.
M Malfunctions of wireless communication between
N Information the vehicle and the driver's key, or a discharged
Information
O e Observe the disposal instructions for batteries. driver's key battery can disable detection of the
driver's key. e If a driver's key is lost or stolen, have a Porsche
P If the battery in the driver's key needs to be replaced, To start the vehicle in this case, observe the partner disable this driver's key in the vehicle and
a message appears on the instrument cluster. The following: change the mechanical locks if necessary.
Q Porsche Crest on the driver’s key no longer lights up 1. Open the storage compartment in the centre e You should notify your insurance company of the
R when buttons are pressed. console armrest. loss or theft of driver's keys or of the production
> Please refer to chapter "Opening the storage of additional or replacement keys.
S compartment in the armrest" on page 220.
T 2. Hold the driver’s key at the centre console – in
the area between the control panel and the stor-
U age compartment in the armrest.
V 3. Turn the control unit to ignition lock position 2
and then back to position 0.
W
4. Turn the control unit to ignition lock position 2
X again.
> Please refer to chapter "Starting and Stop-
Y
Fig. 75: Changing battery
ping the Engine" on page 216.
Z
98
Driving Data Display (Trip Information)
1. CAR e Trip U
99
Driving programmes
100
Driving programmes
101
Driving programmes
J Normal
K During everyday driving, the control systems function in a balance between comfort and fuel economy.
L Sport
M Adjusts the control systems more toward emotionality and dynamism during everyday driving.
N SPORT PLUS
O Maximum performance for racetrack-like operation.
P
Switching the sports exhaust Selecting sports exhaust system in the switch Switching the sports exhaust system on and off via
Q system on and off panel the PCM
R The sports exhaust system can be switched to a 1. Select CAR e DRIVE .
sound-optimised mode.
S 2. Select Exhaust system.
T
U
V
W
X Fig. 80: Button for sports exhaust system
102
Emergency Call System
Emergency Call System process the data transmitted by the emergency call Triggering an emergency call via SOS button A
Different emergency call systems may be used de- system for determination of the necessary rescue
measures (for example, the current position of the B
pending on model, country and equipment. Help can
be requested via the emergency call system in an vehicle is not automatically communicated). C
emergency or in dangerous situations. If the vehicle battery is disconnected or defective, an
integral battery ensures that the emergency call
D
Despite activated private mode, location information
for the vehicle can be transmitted in the event of a system remains available for at least one hour for E
breakdown or emergency call as well as theft. queries from the emergency call centre.
F
Legal emergency call Information G
b Legal emergency call system (for example EU When the cover flap is open, the SOS button can be H
eCall). pressed accidentally, thereby activating an emer- I
b Mobile phone network available. gency call unintentionally.
b Emergency call system is ready for operation e The cover flap for the SOS button must be kept J
(approx. 20 seconds after switching on the closed during driving. K
ignition). e Only press the SOS button in an emergency.
L
Information M
Fig. 81: SOS button and indicator light
The emergency call system does not require a mo- N
bile phone logged on in the vehicle as it features an A SOS button
independent mobile communications module.
B Indicator light O
P
The emergency call system is activated by default Information
upon vehicle delivery. Q
Under unfavourable conditions, an emergency call to An emergency call cannot be activated when the
ignition is switched off. R
an emergency call centre cannot be ensured (e.g. no
mobile phone network available). Due to technical or S
organisational restrictions that lie outside the area of 1. Open the cover plate by pressing on it.
2. Press SOS button A for at least 1 second. If the
T
influence of Porsche (e.g. vehicle outside of the
country coverage of the legal emergency calls sys- SOS button is pressed again for at least 1 second U
tem or no public emergency call infrastructure within 6 seconds, the emergency call is
available), it may be that no emergency call to the cancelled. V
emergency call centre available can be established Indicator light B flashes green while the call to W
under certain circumstances. In countries outside the emergency call centre is being established.
the area of applicability of the legal emergency call 3. If the circumstances allow, wait in the vehicle
X
system, an attempt is made in this case to place an until the connection to the emergency call centre Y
emergency call to an alternative public emergency has been established.
call centre. This public emergency call centre cannot Z
103
Emergency Call System
A Indicator light B flashes green when the call to Flashes green Active emergency call the applicable legal provisions, particular Art. 6 (1)
the emergency call centre has been established. – emergency call is (d) of the GDPR. The emergency call system is not
B If queries from the emergency call centre remain traceable and there is no permanent tracking of the
established and data
C unanswered, rescue measures can be initiated transmission to emer- vehicle. Any data collected is deleted immediately
automatically. after the data transmission.
D gency call centre
The following data is transmitted:
E Information Lights up orange Active automatic – Vehicle identification number
emergency call – – Vehicle type
F If the indicator light flashes, but the emergency call
emergency call is es- – Vehicle drive type
G centre cannot be heard via the loudspeaker, the
tablished and data – Vehicle GPS position data
loudspeaker may be defective, for example. You can,
H however, still be heard by the emergency call centre. transmission to emer- – GPS position data of the route shortly before the
gency call centre emergency call is triggered
I – Log file of automatic activation of the emergency
J Indicator light status display call system
Automatic emergency call
– Time of the triggered emergency call
K – Manually or automatically activated emergency
Indicator light Status
L Information call
Off Emergency call system No automatic emergency call is possible when the – Number of persons in the vehicle
M
is off ignition is switched off. – Direction of travel
N
O
Lights up green Emergency call system A connection to the emergency call centre is estab- Emergency call
is ready for operation lished automatically immediately after triggering of b Mobile phone network available.
P the airbags. The automatic emergency call cannot be
b Emergency call system is ready for operation
Lights up or flashes Error – emergency call prevented by pressing SOS button A.
Q red not or only restrictedly
(approx. 20 seconds after switching on the
If queries from the emergency call centre remain ignition).
R possible1 unanswered, rescue measures can be initiated.
S Data transmission Information
T During an emergency call, person and vehicle-re- The emergency call system does not require a mo-
lated data for determination of the necessary rescue bile phone logged on in the vehicle as it features an
U
measures is transmitted to the emergency call independent mobile communications module.
V centre, provided that this is available.
Collection and transmission of the data to emer- Under unfavourable conditions, an emergency call to
W
gency service control centres is solely for the pur- an emergency call centre cannot be ensured (e.g. no
X pose of using the emergency call system within the mobile phone network available).
specified emergency situations and in the context of
Y
Z
1. Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Porsche recommends a Porsche partner as they have trained workshop personnel and the necessary parts and tools.
104
Emergency Call System
Due to technical or organisational restrictions that lie Triggering an emergency call via SOS button Indicator light B flashes green while the call to A
outside the area of influence of Porsche (e.g. vehicle the emergency call centre is being established.
outside of the emergency call country coverage), it B
3. If the circumstances allow, wait in the vehicle
may be that no emergency call to the designated until the connection to the emergency call centre C
emergency call centre can be established under has been established.
certain circumstances. In this case, if legally per- D
Indicator light B flashes green when the call to
missible an emergency call to an alternative public the emergency call centre has been established. E
emergency call centre is established. A public If queries from the emergency call centre remain
emergency call centre may not be able to process unanswered, rescue measures are initiated F
the data transmitted by the emergency call system automatically. G
for determination of the necessary rescue measures
(for example, the current position of the vehicle is H
not automatically communicated).
Information
I
If the vehicle battery is disconnected or defective, an If the indicator light flashes, but the emergency call
integral battery ensures that the emergency call centre cannot be heard via the loudspeaker, the J
system remains available for at least one hour for loudspeaker may be defective, for example. You can, K
queries from the emergency call centre. however, still be heard by the emergency call centre.
L
Information M
Fig. 82: SOS button and indicator light Indicator light status display
When the cover flap is open, the SOS button can be N
A SOS button
pressed accidentally, thereby activating an emer- Indicator light Status
gency call unintentionally.
B Indicator light O
e The cover flap for the SOS button must be kept Off Emergency call system P
closed during driving. Information is off Q
e Only press the SOS button in an emergency.
An emergency call cannot be activated when the
Lights up green Emergency call system R
ignition is switched off.
is ready for operation
S
1. Open the cover plate by pressing on it.
2. Press SOS button A for at least 1 second. If the
Lights up or flashes Error – emergency call T
red not or only restrictedly
SOS button is pressed again for at least 1 second U
possible1
within 6 seconds, the emergency call is
cancelled. V
W
X
Y
Z
1. Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Porsche recommends a Porsche partner as they have trained workshop personnel and the necessary parts and tools.
105
Emergency Call System
106
Engine Compartment Lid
Engine Compartment Lid by pressing on the lock area with the palm of A
your hand.
B
Opening and closing engine com- 2. Check that the engine compartment lid has en-
gaged correctly in the lock. C
partment lid If the engine compartment lid is not closed
D
properly, a message appears on the instrument
Opening engine compartment lid
cluster when the vehicle is moving. E
Cabriolet: F
e Pull button B.
G
Engine compartment lid (convertible-top com-
partment lid) closes automatically. H
I
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
Fig. 84: Opening engine compartment lid Q
A Luggage compartment lid button
B Engine compartment lid button R
S
e Pull button B.
Coupé: Engine compartment lid is unlocked and T
can be raised.
U
Cabriolet: Engine compartment lid (convertible-
top compartment lid) opens automatically to V
service position.
W
Closing engine compartment lid X
Coupé: Y
1. Lower the engine compartment lid and let it fall
into the lock. Close the engine compartment lid
Z
107
Engine oil
A Engine oil e Vehicle e Oil level Never add more than the indicated quantity of
engine oil. The difference between the minimum
B
Checking engine-oil level and maximum mark is approx. 1.3 litres.
C Depending on the driving style and the operating If the display is yellow up to the top edge D, the
conditions the oil consumption may be up to maximum permitted engine filling capacity has been
D exceeded. This can cause damage to the vehicle.
0.8 litres/1000 km. The oil level should be checked
E regularly (e.g. every time vehicle is refuelled). Have the oil level corrected at the next opportunity.
e Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Porsche
F
Responding to oil level warning recommends a Porsche partner as they have
G If the oil level is too low, a symbol appears on the trained workshop personnel and the necessary
instrument cluster indicating that the engine must parts and tools.
H
be topped up with oil immediately.
I Selecting and topping up engine
J Measuring and displaying engine oil level oil
K NOTICE Engine compartment
WARNING
blowers and other mov-
L ing parts in the area of
Risk of engine damage.
M the engine
If the oil level is below the minimum mark on the oil- Fig. 85: Oil-level indicator
N level indicator, the engine will not be sufficiently
A Oil level sufficient - maximum reached Hands, fingers, items of clothing, necklaces or long
lubricated. B Oil level minimum reached hair can be drawn in by moving parts, e.g. the en-
O
e Check the oil level regularly. C Oil level below minimum gine-compartment blowers or drive belt, when
P e Do not allow the oil level to fall below the mini- D Oil level above maximum working in the engine compartment. The engine-
mum mark. compartment blowers are installed under the engine
Q If the display is green A, the oil level has reached the
cover. After the engine is stopped, the engine com-
maximum mark and is sufficient.
R Information If the bottom segment of the display is yellow B, the
partment temperature continues to be monitored.
The engine-compartment blowers may continue to
S oil level has reached the minimum mark.
Under certain circumstances, the oil level cannot be run or start to run.
e Add the quantity of engine oil shown on the in-
T measured. Causes of this include:
strument cluster at the next opportunity. e Carry out work in this area only with the engine
U – Engine is cold Never add more than the indicated quantity of stopped while exercising extreme caution and
– Vehicle parked following full-throttle operation engine oil. The difference between the minimum take great care to ensure that parts of the body,
V at high engine speeds and maximum mark is approx. 1.3 litres. articles of clothing or jewellery cannot be caught
W – Engine oil temperature too high If the bottom segment is red C, the oil level has in the radiator fan, engine-compartment blower,
dropped below the minimum mark. drive belt or other moving parts.
X b Vehicle is horizontal. 1. Stop in a suitable place.
Y b Engine at operating temperature and stopped for 2. Add the quantity of engine oil shown on the in-
at least one minute. strument cluster immediately.
Z
108
Engine oil
Burning engine oil system in the long term. Topping up engine oil A
WARNING
e Do not allow the oil level to fall below the mini- B
Engine oil can ignite if it comes into contact with hot mum mark.
engine parts. Engine oil stored in non-ventilated e Only add engine oil up to the maximum mark. If C
areas or thrown-away cloths with engine oil residues the oil reservoir is overfilled, correct this at the D
can self-combust and result in a fire. earliest opportunity. Visit a qualified specialist
E
e Wipe up spilled engine oil with a cloth. workshop. Porsche recommends a Porsche part-
e Cloths soaked with engine oil must be stored in a ner as they have trained workshop personnel and F
well-ventilated area until disposal. the necessary parts and tools.
G
e Allow the engine to cool down before topping up Always observe the following points:
engine oil. H
– Only use engine oils approved by Porsche. Ob-
serve the service intervals. I
Hot engine parts
WARNING – Oils approved by Porsche can be mixed.
J
– Do not use oil additives.
The engine, adjacent components and the exhaust – If an engine oil leak is suspected, have the engine K
system become very hot when the engine is running. checked immediately. L
e Touching poses an acute risk of burns.
e Take care when working near hot vehicle parts, Selecting engine oil Fig. 86: Oil filler opening M
particularly the engine and the exhaust system. Porsche recommends . N
1. Read the engine-oil level in the instrument
e Before working in the engine compartment, al- If there is a sticker in the engine compartment in- cluster.
ways switch the engine off and let it cool dicating an approved engine oil designation, this O
2. Open theengine compartment lid.
sufficiently. information has priority over the information in this P
3. Unscrew cap of the oil filler opening.
e Exercise extreme caution when working in the Manual.
4. Add the quantity of engine oil shown on the in- Q
engine compartment. If in doubt and in order to find out the current ap-
strument cluster.
e Top up engine oil only with the engine stopped proval status, please contact a Porsche partner.
Never add more than the indicated quantity of R
and ignition switched off. engine oil. The difference between the minimum
Vehicle Approval SAE viscosity S
class and maximum mark is approx. 1.3 litres.
NOTICE 5. Carefully close cap on the oil filler opening. T
All Porsche C40, SAE 0W-40 1 U
Not enough or too much engine oil will damage the alternatively: SAE 5W-40 2
engine. Too much engine oil can result in blue smoke VW 511 00
V
formation and cause damage to the emission control W
X
Y
1. For all temperature ranges. Z
2. For the temperature range above -25 °C.
109
Flat Tyre
110
Flat Tyre
111
Flat Tyre
A 1. Unfasten retaining strap and guide through the align so that both loops are pointing in the di-
loops. rection of travel and form a horizontal line.
B
2. Unfasten Velcro loops and guide seat belt 5. Guide the seat belt upwards through the Velcro
C downwards. loops.
3. Remove the bag with the collapsible spare wheel. 6. Guide the retaining strap through the loops and
D
4. Unfasten the seat belt and remove the foam tie securely.
E rubber insert from the rear seat.
5. Pull the retaining strap upwards on left and right If the collapsible spare wheel is defective:
F
and remove. e Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Porsche
G 6. Fit the collapsible spare wheel to the vehicle be- recommends a Porsche partner as they have
fore inflating it. Leave the vehicle jacked up. trained workshop personnel and the necessary
H
> Please refer to chapter "Tyres and Wheels" parts and tools.
I on page 238.
J 7. Inflate the tyre.
> Please refer to chapter "Tyres and Wheels"
K on page 238.
L
After using the collapsible spare wheel
M e Deflate the collapsible spare wheel. Unscrew the
N valve cap on the collapsible spare wheel for this
purpose.
O The tyre will revert to its original shape only after
P several hours. Only then can it be stowed in the bag
provided or in the foam rubber insert for transport-
Q ing the spare wheel.
R 1. Guide the retaining strap behind the rear seat
backrest from the top left and right and pull
S downwards.
T 2. Position the foam rubber insert on the rear seat
so that recess for the collapsible spare wheel
U points in the direction of travel.
V 3. Guide the seat belt around the foam rubber in-
sert, fasten and guide downwards to the seat
W cushion.
X 4. Place the bag with the collapsible spare wheel
into the recess in the foam rubber insert and
Y
Z
112
Front axle lift system
Front axle lift system Raising the front end The vehicle is lowered to the basic level. The A
The front axle lift system enables the body to be button flashes red and a message appears on the
instrument cluster. B
raised electro-hydraulically at the front by about
40 mm (front edge of front spoiler). This prevents When the front end is fully lowered: C
damage to the body, which can occur when driving – The red lighting of the button goes out.
D
in underground car parks or over speed bumps, for – A message appears briefly indicating that the
example. front end is lowered. E
F
Operational readiness and Information
G
behaviour If a door is opened during the lowering process, the
– The front axle lift system is operational when the Fig. 88: Button for lift system
front end is raised again automatically. H
engine is running and the vehicle is stationary or b Engine is running. I
up to a maximum speed of approx. 35km/h (
e Press button . NOTICE
22 mph) or approx. 60 km/h (37 mph) in certain J
countries. The vehicle is raised at the front axle within ap-
prox. 5 seconds. Risk of damage through bottoming of vehicle. K
– The vehicle is automatically lowered to the basic
The button flashes red and a message appears
level again when a minimum speed of approx. e Do not lower the vehicle when it is positioned L
35 km/h (22 mph) is exceeded (approx. on the instrument cluster.
above an obstacle. M
60 km/h (37 mph) in certain countries). When the front end is fully raised:
– When raised, the damping properties of the front – The button lights up red. N
axle change and noise may be heard in the area – A message appears briefly indicating that the
front end is raised. O
of the front axle coil springs during steering
movements. P
NOTICE
– At temperatures below approx. - 10 °C, it may
Q
take longer to fully raise the front end of the ve-
hicle. The noise level may increase. Risk of damage through uncontrolled lowering of the
R
front end when the engine is stopped.
S
Lift system faults In this particular system, the holding position cannot
be maintained at the upper position over an ex- T
Front axle lift system faults are displayed on the in-
tended period.
strument cluster. U
> Please refer to chapter "Warning and Information e Always park the vehicle in the lowered position.
Messages" on page 255. V
W
Lowering the front end
b Doors are closed. X
b Engine is running. Y
e Press button .
Z
113
Fuses
A Fuses Fuse ratings plastic gripper in order to check it. A blown fuse
Short-circuit can be identified by the melted metal strip.
B WARNING
Colour Amperage 5. Insert the new fuse. Only use fuses with the
C rating same rating as the fuse you are replacing.
Working on the vehicle’s electrical system can cause 6. Fit the purple plastic strip back into place.
D a short-circuit. The short circuit can cause a fire.
Light brown 5A If the same fuse blows repeatedly, the cause of the
E e Always detach the negative terminal on the bat- fault must be corrected immediately.
F
tery when working on the electrical system. Brown 7.5 A e Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Porsche
recommends a Porsche partner as they have
G Improper intervention Red 10 A trained workshop personnel and the necessary
WARNING
and incorrect parts and tools.
H accessories Blue 15 A
I
Improper intervention in the fuse box and the use of Opening the fuse box in the driv-
Yellow 20 A
J the incorrect accessories can result in damage and er's footwell
malfunctions in electrical and electronic systems.
K White / clear 25 A
e Do not attempt to replace any electrical compo-
L nents except the fuses (e.g. relays) listed here. Green 30 A
M e Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Porsche
recommends a Porsche partner as they have Blue-green 35 A
N trained workshop personnel and the necessary
O parts and tools. Orange 40 A
e Only use accessories that have been approved by
P Porsche. For information on approved accesso-
ries: Contact your Porsche partner.
Checking and changing fuses
Q
The numbering of the fuse slots is printed or em-
R bossed on the inside of the cover of or on the fuse
S Checking and changing fuses carrier.
In order to prevent damage to the electrical system Unassigned fuse slots are not listed in the following
T due to short circuits and overloads, the individual overviews.
circuits are protected by fuses. 1. Switch off the load with the defective fuse if
U
Fuse boxes are located in the footwell on the driver's possible.
V and passenger's side. 2. Open the relevant fuse box cover.
Fig. 89: Opening the fuse box in the driver's footwell
W Depending on the equipment, further fuse boxes are 3. If necessary, carefully remove the purple plastic
located at various locations in the vehicle, which are strip over the fuses.
X only accessible to a specialist workshop. 4. Remove the fuse from its slot using the yellow
Y
Z
114
Fuses
115
Fuses
A Row B
B
No. Load
C
4 Seat belt, front right
D
E 6 All-wheel drive control unit
W 8 Ioniser
X 9 Brake booster control unit
Y
Z
116
Garage door opener (HomeLink®)
117
Garage door opener (HomeLink®)
118
HOLD function
119
Instrument Cluster
A Instrument Cluster
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
Q Fig. 91: Instrument cluster
R
S A - Speed & Assist display B – Tachometer D – Car & Info display
T Information on the time, outside temperature, speed The start of the red zone on the tachometer scale is Information on the driving programme, vehicle sta-
and assistance systems is shown in tubes 1 and 2. a visual warning of the maximum permissible engine tus and driver assistance is shown in tubes 4 and 5.
U For information on the Speed & Assist display speed. For information on the Car & Info display settings:
V settings: > Please refer to chapter "Vehicle Settings" on
> Please refer to chapter "Vehicle Settings" on C – Digital speedometer page 246.
W page 246. Information on the speed, selector lever position and
X engaged gear is displayed in the digital
speedometer.
Y
Z
120
Instrument Cluster
E – Fuel gauge The warning light comes on or flashes. – The warning light comes on or flashes when the A
e If the gauge needle is in the red area, stop im- engine is running or while driving.
B
NOTICE mediately in a suitable place and switch off the Porsche recommends a Porsche partner as they
engine. Do not continue driving. have trained workshop personnel and the necessary C
A shortage of fuel may damage the emission control parts and tools. D
system. Bar in left area – engine cold
e Never drive the tank dry. e Avoid high engine speeds and heavy engine High beam indicator light E
e If the fuel range warning has appeared, do not loading. Dynamic high beam indicator light F
take bends at high speed.
Bar in centre area – normal operating temperature Dipped beam indicator light G
If the vehicle’s inclination changes (e.g. driving uphill e The bar may move up to the red area when the
Rear fog light indicator light H
or downhill), minor deviations in the display may engine is heavily loaded and outside temperature
occur. is high. Porsche Dynamic Light System Plus I
(PDLS Plus) warning light
Fuel reserve warning Bar in red area – operating temperature is too high J
If the fuel level falls below a model-dependent re- e If the coolant level is low, warning messages may Lights warning light
maining range, a fuel range warning message is appear if the vehicle tilts at an extreme angle (e. K
Coolant temperature warning light
displayed. g. steep slopes) or generates high lateral accel- L
e Refuel at the next opportunity. eration while travelling around long bends (e.g. Engine control system warning light
> Please refer to chapter "Refuelling" on driving in circles). If the warning messages do M
Engine control system warning light
page 191. not disappear once the vehicle has assumed
N
"normal" operating state, check the coolant level. Distance warning warning light
Identification for location of filler flap > Please refer to chapter "Coolant" on page 90. Tyre pressure warning light
O
The arrow points towards the side of the During the teach-in process for newly P
vehicle on which the filler flap is located.
F – Boost pressure display fitted wheels or tyre pressure sensors, in
Depending on the vehicle equipment, the boost the event of pressure loss in a tyre, a Q
F – Coolant temperature gauge pressure is shown in the display. fault or a temporary malfunction of the R
Tyre Pressure Monitoring (TPM) system,
NOTICE Warning and indicator lights the warning light may flash or light up. S
All-wheel warning light T
Excessively high coolant temperature can cause en- NOTICE
gine damage. Assistance systems warning light U
If the coolant temperature is too high, the coolant Faults are indicated by the warning lights. The cor- Electric parking brake warning light V
temperature gauge needle moves to the maximum responding warning light only goes out when the
Porsche Active Suspension Management W
mark. A warning appears on the instrument cluster. cause of the fault has been rectified.
(PASM) warning light
Consult a qualified specialist workshop in the fol- X
Anti-lock brake system (ABS) warning
lowing cases: light Y
– The warning light does not come on briefly when Power steering warning light
the ignition is switched on. Z
121
Instrument Cluster
A Central warning light Operating the instrument cluster A -Adjust the volume and mute the audio
Direction indicator, left source
B Setting and operating
WARNING
while driving e Adjust volume: Turn rotary knob A upwards or
Direction indicator, right
C downwards.
D Airbag warning light Setting and operating the multi-function steering e Mute: Press rotary knob A.
Seat belt warning light wheel, infotainment system, etc. while driving may
E distract you from the traffic situation. You may lose B - Call up voice control
F
Brake system warning light control of the vehicle. e Press button B.
Brake pad warning light e Only operate these components while driving if
G the traffic situation allows you to do so safely. C - Call up the stored function
H Porsche Stability Management (PSM) e In case of doubt, safely pull out of traffic and only
warning light carry out extensive operations and settings while Assign quick access buttons
I Porsche Stability Management (PSM) the vehicle is stationary. e Press button C. The button on the steering wheel
J OFF warning light and in the switch panel can be individually
Night View Assist indicator light The instrument cluster is only active when the igni- assigned.
K tion is on. For safety reasons, some functions are > Please refer to chapter "Vehicle Settings" on
HOLD function indicator light only available when the vehicle is stationary. page 246.
L
Emission control warning light (Check
M Engine) D - Play next/previous station/track
N In the event of malfunctions (e.g. engine e Press button D.
misfiring) that could increase pollutant
O emissions or cause consequential dam- E - Scroll and select menus and functions in
P age the warning light may flash or light the Speed & Assist 1 and Car & Info 2
up. displays
Q e Scrolling: Turn rotary knob E upwards or
If the emission control (Check Engine) warning
R light flashes or lights up downwards.
e Reduce engine speed and load immediately. e Select/Enter: Press rotary knob E.
S
e If necessary, stop in a suitable safe place. Make
T sure that combustible materials such as dry F - Switch between the Speed & Assist 1 and
grass or leaves cannot come into contact with Car & Info 2 displays
U
the hot exhaust system. e Press button F.
V e Initiate measures to resolve the emission control
fault. G - Go back one or more selection levels in the
W
Car & Info 2 display
X Fig. 92: Operating instrument cluster with multi-function e Press button G.
steering wheel
Y
H - Accept a telephone call
Z e Press button H.
122
Instrument Cluster
123
Instrument Cluster
K 1 e Time, outside temperature, date Display digital or analogue clock, out- > p. 246
L side temperature and date. The choice
of display can be adjusted via the PCM.
M
N 1 e Compass Display the compass.
124
Instrument Cluster
e Telephone
J
4 Use connected phone. > p. 222
K
4 e Vehicle Display vehicle information (informa- > p. 126
L
tion, messages, service intervals and
fill levels). M
e Trip > p. 99 N
4 Display and reset driving data (average
fuel consumption, range, driving time, O
etc.).
P
4/5 e Map Show and adapt the map display. > p. 159 Q
125
Instrument Cluster
126
Interior lighting
127
Jack and Lifting Platform
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
W
X
Y
Fig. 95: Rear jacking point for jack and lifting platform
Z
128
Jump-lead Starting
129
Jump-lead Starting
A terminal of the donor battery. Never connect the Repeated jump-lead starting under normal operating NOTICE
black negative cable directly to the battery. conditions may indicate that the battery is damaged.
B
6. Connect the black negative cable to the ground Unsuitable jump leads Risk of damage if jump-lead starting is performed on
C point –. WARNING
and incorrect procedures an exhaustively discharged lithium battery.
7. Allow the engine of the donor vehicle to run at a
D e If you suspect exhaustive discharge of a lithium
higher engine speed. A short circuit may be caused if unsuitable jump
battery, do not attempt jump-lead starting.
E 8. Start the engine. An attempted start using jump leads are used or if jump-lead starting is not per-
leads should not last more than 15 seconds. formed properly. Short circuits can cause fires.
F
Then wait for at least one minute. e Use only standard jump leads with sufficient Performing jump-lead starting
G 9. With engine running: cross section and completely insulated terminal
First, disconnect the black negative cable from clamps. Follow the instructions provided by the
H
the ground point – then from the negative ter- jump lead manufacturer.
I minal of the donor battery. e The vehicles must not touch, otherwise current
10.With engine running: may flow as soon as the positive terminals are
J
Disconnect the red positive cable from the pos- connected.
K itive terminal of the donor battery first, then from e Ensure that conductive jewellery (e.g. rings,
the positive terminal for jump-lead starting +.
L chains, watch straps) does not come into contact
with live parts of the vehicle.
M Lithium battery jump-lead e Never connect jump leads directly to the battery
N starting or other electrical components. Only connect
O b Vehicle with lithium battery jump leads to the jump-lead starting terminals.
The 12-volt lithium battery is automatically discon-
P Escaping electrolyte fluid
nected from the vehicle electrical system if the bat- WARNING
tery charge condition is low. The electrical system is and toxic gases
Q
deactivated temporarily. When the battery is
Risk of electrolyte fluid and toxic gases escaping in
R charged (for at least 10 minutes) or when jump-lead
exceptional cases if the battery is damaged or
starting or connection to an external power supply
S handled incorrectly. Fig. 97: Lithium battery terminals
take place, the electrical system is automatically re-
T activated. The 12-volt lithium battery is automati- e Avoid any inhalation of the vapours and any skin 1. Open the luggage compartment.
cally reconnected to the vehicle electrical system. contact with the electrolyte fluid. > Please refer to chapter "Performing emer-
U e Keep people away and stay on the side facing gency release of luggage compartment lid"
Another vehicle's battery can be used for starting
V and as an external power supply with the help of into the wind. on page 150.
jump leads. Both batteries must have a nominal e Only charge lithium batteries in well-ventilated 2. Remove cover in luggage compartment
W voltage of 12 V. The capacity (Ah) of the donor bat- rooms.
X tery must not be substantially less than that of the
flat battery. The flat battery must be properly con-
Y nected to the vehicle electrical system.
Z > Please refer to chapter "Battery" on page 52.
130
Jump-lead Starting
131
Lane Change Assist (LCA)
A Lane Change Assist (LCA) e ASSIST e Lane Change Assist that, owing to the small differences in speed be-
Lane Change Assist warns the driver about vehicles tween your vehicle and moving or stationary ob-
B When Lane Change Assist is active, the indicator in
approaching from behind or those in the blind-spot. the exterior mirror lights up briefly when the ignition jects, fixed objects (e.g. a metal post) trigger a
C This applies when overtaking other vehicles and is switched on. warning, or that slow-moving vehicles are not
when being overtaken. Integrated warning indicators detected.
D Lack of attention – The Rear Turn Assist is activated when driving
A in both exterior mirrors light up as soon as a dan- WARNING
E gerous situation is identified and changing lanes off. It can therefore occur that vehicles which are
seems essential. already moving or are driving off are not detected
F Even with Lane Change Assist and Rear Turn Assist,
At driving speeds below the operating range of the or are only detected late. Vehicles already lo-
absolute care and attention on the part of the driver
G Lane Change Assist, the additional Rear Turn Assist cated immediately next to your vehicle and
is still required while driving. Ultimately, the driver is
also supports the driver by monitoring the area be- therefore outside the detection range of the
H still responsible for changing lanes.
hind the vehicle in turning-off situations. Rear Turn sensor may also not be detected.
e Keep the direction of travel and the relevant area – If, when turning-off, your vehicle is not facing in
I Assist is always automatically switched to standby
around the vehicle in view at all times. the direction of the driving lane, but is facing di-
together with Lane Change Assist.
J agonally or at right angles to it, approaching ve-
Restricted range of the hicles can no longer be detected by the sensors.
K WARNING
radar sensor
e Keep the direction of travel and the relevant area
L around the vehicle in view at all times.
The view of the radar sensor can be reduced in tight
M bends, when approaching crests and in adverse
weather conditions (rain, snow, ice, heavy spray).
N
Vehicles will not be detected properly or may not be
O detected at all.
P e Observe the direction of travel and the relevant
area around the vehicle closely at all times.
Q
Vehicles not detected
R WARNING
S
Vehicles cannot or may not be detected in time in
T the following situations:
U – There is no indication in the case of vehicles ap-
Fig. 98: Warning indicator A on the exterior mirror proaching at high speed from behind or vehicles
V that are falling back.
W Switching Lane Change Assist on – Lane Change Assist will not work in tight bends.
– Lane Change Assist will only alert you to ap-
X and off proaching vehicles or vehicles in the blind-spot
Y Lane Change Assist can be switched on and off in area when you are driving at approx. 15 km/h (
the PCM. 9 mph) or faster.
Z
– In the case of the Rear Turn Assist, it may occur
132
Lane Change Assist (LCA)
General information Information rear bumper. The radar sensors calculate an area of A
– The system provides assistance when driving at up to 70 m to the rear (approach zone) and the
To ensure that Lane Change Assist can work blind-spot. B
speeds above approx. 15 km/h (9 mph).
– At speeds below 15 km/h (9 mph), the driver is properly: Whenever Lane Change Assist regards the speed C
supported by the Rear Turn Assist, however, on e Do not cover the radar sensors on the rear difference and distance as critical for changing
bumper with objects (e.g. stickers). Also remove lanes, this is indicated on the relevant exterior mirror.
D
the vehicle side where the direction indicator
was actuated and only when driving off. any dirt, snow and ice from this area. Both sides of the vehicle are displayed separately. E
– The Rear Turn Assist is active up to approx. 20 e Do not cover the warning indicator in the exterior This is how the warning indicator in the left exterior
mirror (e.g. with stickers or self-adhesive blind mirror assists the driver when changing to the left F
km/h (12 mph).
– Lane Change Assist and Rear Turn Assist are not spot mirrors). lane, for example. G
available if the system detects that the radar e Subsequent painting of the bumper may lead to a If a vehicle regarded as critical has switched on its
reduction in the sensor range owing to the direction indicator, the respective warning indicator H
sensors are covered.
thicker coating layer. The electrical properties in the exterior mirror flashes brightly and briefly I
– The radar sensors can sometimes detect other
objects (e.g. high or raised crash barriers), not may also differ from those of the approved several times.
paints. When slowly overtaking another vehicle (speed dif- J
just vehicles.
– The display is designed so that you notice it ference of less than approx. 15 km/h (9 mph)), the K
merely by glancing at the exterior mirror. warning indicator lights up as soon as this vehicle is
in your blind-spot area and is detected by Lane L
Change Assist. If there is a greater speed difference, M
Information this is not indicated in the exterior mirror.
The speed range of the Lane Change Assist is not N
If the position of the radar sensors was changed fol-
lowing an accident, for example, this can impair the reached immediately after driving off. Until it is O
function of Lane Change Assist. reached, the driver is supported via the Rear Turn
P
e Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Porsche Assist.
recommends a Porsche partner as they have When the direction indicator is on, the Rear Turn Q
trained workshop personnel and the necessary Assist detects objects located next to and behind
parts and tools. your vehicle, but only at the side on which the indi- R
cator has been activated. If a potential hazard is de- S
tected, the respective warning indicator on the
exterior mirror lights up. If your own calculated driv- T
ing path crosses that of a detected vehicle on the
U
side of the vehicle on which the indicator has been
activated, the respective warning indicator on the V
Fig. 99: Radar sensors in the rear bumper exterior mirror will flash brightly and briefly several
times. W
Operating principle X
Lane Change Assist measures the distance and Y
speed difference of detected vehicles compared to
your vehicle using the radar sensors integrated in the Z
133
Lane Change Assist (LCA)
134
Lane Change Assist (LCA)
Vehicles approaching slowly mirror flashes briefly several times. Lane Change Assist alerts you to the fact that you may have A
Assist alerts you to the fact that you may have overlooked a vehicle.
overlooked a vehicle. B
Vehicles falling back quickly C
Vehicles falling back slowly
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
Fig. 101: Vehicle approaching slowly
N
A – Warning indicator in exterior mirror does not
light up O
Fig. 103: Vehicle falling back quickly
The sensors detect a slowly approaching vehicle – in
Fig. 102: Vehicle falling back slowly
A – Warning indicator in exterior mirror does not
P
the left lane in the example. Due to the small speed
difference and the large distance, the warning indi- A – Warning indicator in exterior mirror does not light up Q
cator in the exterior mirror does not light up. light up Lane Change Assist has not yet detected the over-
B – Warning indicator lights up in the information Lane Change Assist has not yet detected the over- taken vehicle. Warning indicator in exterior mirror R
stage taken vehicle. Warning indicator in exterior mirror does not light up. S
The slowly approaching vehicle is now closer. Warn- does not light up. B – Warning indicator in exterior mirror does not
B – Warning indicator lights up in the information light up
T
ing indicator in exterior mirror lights up. Only when
Lane Change Assist regards the speed difference stage Lane Change Assist detects the vehicle on the right U
and distance as critical for changing lanes, does the The slowly receding vehicle (less than approx. that is falling back fast (speed difference of more
15 km/h speed difference) – in the right lane in the than approx. 15 km/h (9 mph)) – in the right lane in
V
warning indicator in the exterior mirror light up. You
are alerted to all vehicles detected by Lane Change example – is detected by Lane Change Assist. the example – but does not regard it as critical for W
Assist when they are in the "blind-spot area" at the Warning indicator in exterior mirror lights up. changing lanes because it is falling back fast. Warn-
latest. C – Warning indicator flashes in the warning stage ing indicator in exterior mirror does not light up. X
C – Warning indicator flashes in the warning stage If the direction indicator is switched on in driving C – Warning indicator in exterior mirror does not Y
If the direction indicator is switched on in driving situation B, the warning indicator in the exterior light up
mirror flashes briefly several times. Lane Change
Z
situation B, the warning indicator in the exterior
135
Lane Change Assist (LCA)
A If the direction indicator is switched on in driving If, in driving situation B, the driver has initiated
situation B, the warning indicator in the exterior turning off by steering to the relevant side and this
B mirror is still not activated. results in his own calculated driving path crossing
C that of a detected vehicle, the warning indicator in
Pulling away to turn off the exterior mirror flashes briefly several times and
D then lights up. This warns you of a potential collision
E with a vehicle that may have been overlooked.
F
Driving around bends
G When driving around a bend, Lane Change Assist
H may react to a vehicle driving in the next lane but
one and the warning indicator in the exterior mirror
I may light up.
J Lane Change Assist cannot detect vehicles in tight
bends.
K e Take additional care when driving around bends
L and where there are lanes with differing widths.
Fig. 105: Lane width and detection area
M Lane width
N The Lane Change Assist detection area covers the
two adjacent lanes (left and right) on lanes of
O
standard width regardless of whether you are driving
P Fig. 104: Pulling away to turn off exactly in the middle or at the edge of the lane.
A – Warning indicator in exterior mirror does not When driving on narrow lanes, this area may cover
Q
light up even more lanes, particularly when driving at the
R edge of a lane. In such situations, vehicles driving
The direction indicator has not been actuated. The
two lanes away may be detected and Lane Change
S Rear Turn Assist is therefore not active after driving
Assist may switch to the information or warning
off and the motorbike located in the blind spot is not
T stage.
detected. A fast approaching vehicle may also not be
detected. Warning indicator in exterior mirror does Likewise, when driving on very wide lanes, vehicles
U in the adjacent lane may not be detected as they are
not light up.
V outside the detection area.
B – Warning indicator lights up in the information
W stage
If the relevant direction indicator is switched on in
X driving situation A, the warning indicator in the ex-
Y terior mirror lights up. Turn assist alerts you to the
fact that you may have overlooked a vehicle.
Z C – Warning indicator flashes in the warning stage
136
Lane Keep Assist
Lane Keep Assist direction indicator is actuated for the relevant di- e Never use Lane Keep Assist in the following A
rection. At the same time as a steering intervention, situations:
the relevant side appears in red on the status display B
– When increased attention is required on the
and an acoustic warning (if active) is provided when part of the driver. C
the lane marking is crossed over. – During sporty driving.
D
Lack of attention – In adverse weather conditions (e.g. fog, snow
WARNING E
or heavy rain).
– Under unfavourable road conditions (includ- F
The driver remains responsible at all times when ing bad roads, pot holes, dirty road surfaces).
driving, e.g. staying in lane, despite active Lane Keep – In roadworks areas. G
Assist. The system is no substitute for attention on
Fig. 106: Windscreen camera – When approaching humps and dips. H
the part of the driver.
– In urban traffic.
Using the front camera A and within the limits of the – The system can help to keep the vehicle in the I
system, Lane Keep Assist detects the course of the – On winding and narrow country roads.
lane within the limits of the system, but it does
road ahead based on the lane markings. When the not drive it. Keep your hands on the steering e Drive with extreme care. J
vehicle approaches a detected lane marking and is in wheel at all times in order to always be ready to e Always pay attention to the traffic situation and K
danger of leaving the driving lane, the system ini- steer. If a warning message appears on the in- the area around the vehicle.
tiates corrective steering intervention that helps to strument cluster, take over control of the vehicle e Adapt your driving speed to road and weather L
keep the vehicle in the lane. The driver receives a yourself immediately. conditions. M
visual indication of the steering intervention in the – In the case of heavy braking, for example, cor- e Do not attach any objects to the steering wheel.
status display. The driver can override the steering rective steering interventions may not take N
intervention at any time. place. Failure of camera to de-
WARNING O
If the vehicle crosses a lane marking without indi- – In the case of active steering by the driver, cor- tect the lane
cating, the system alerts the driver to the fact rective steering intervention can be reduced or P
acoustically. For this purpose, the acoustic warning Camera vision can be impaired by various factors (e.
may not take place. Q
g. rain, snow, ice, heavy spray, oncoming headlights
must be enabled in the PCM in the ASSIST – It is possible that not all lane marking will be de-
menu. or damage). Under certain conditions, the camera R
tected. Steering intervention can only take place
cannot detect the lane markings, or cannot detect
The system is designed for driving on highways and on the side where a lane marking has been S
them correctly. In this case, no steering intervention
well-surfaced country roads and works in a speed detected.
range of approx. 40 mph (65 km/h) – 156 mph or unexpected steering intervention can occur. T
– Other road structures or objects may be incor-
(250 km/h). The operative system does not issue a rectly identified as lane markings. This can lead e Drive with extreme care.
U
warning or steer if the driver indicates before cross- to unexpected or missing steering interventions/ e Keep the direction of travel and the lane lines in
ing a lane marking. In these situations, the system acoustic warnings. view at all times. V
interprets the lane change as intentional. – Corrective steering intervention alone may not e Clean the camera lens regularly and keep free of
W
b Vehicles with Lane Change Assist: be sufficient to keep the vehicle in the driving snow and ice.
If the vehicle is equipped with Lane Change Assist, lane in the case of track ruts, winding roads, in- e Do not cover the camera lens. X
the driver is warned through corrective steering in- clined road surfaces or crosswind. The driver e Check the windscreen for damage in the area of
Y
tervention back into lane when changing lanes in a must actively steer in such situations. the camera lens at regular intervals.
potentially critical situation. This also happens if the Z
137
Lane Keep Assist
A Information Switching Lane Keep Assist on Calling up and reading off Lane
B e If there is a fault in the system or if Lane Keep
and off Keep Assist
Assist does not function as described in this Lane Keep Assist can be switched on and off in the
C PCM.
section, do not use Lane Keep Assist. Visit a
D qualified specialist workshop. e ASSIST e Lane Keep Assist
E Porsche recommends a Porsche partner as they
have trained workshop personnel and the neces-
F sary parts and tools. Setting acoustic warning
G The acoustic warning can be switched on and off
No corrective steering individually. The warning tone volume can also be
H WARNING
intervention selected in 3 stages.
I In tighter bends and with Lane Keep Assist active,
e ASSIST e e Assistance system set-
corrective steering intervention is not sufficient to
J tings e Lane Keep Assist
keep the vehicle in the lane. It can also happen that
K Lane Keep Assist is automatically deactivated before
L or in the bend and no corrective steering interven-
tion occurs.
M
e Drive with extreme care.
N e Always hold the steering wheel with both hands.
Fig. 107: Speed & Assist display
O A Lane Keep Assist display
Information B Display of lane markings
P
C Status display
The driver's steering behaviour is monitored when
Q Lane Keep Assist is active. If no more steering ac-
R tivity is detected and the vehicle is about to stray Vehicles with Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
from the lane several times, the instrument cluster The Speed & Assist display in the ASSIST main
S issues an acoustic and visual warning and prompts menu shows the lane markings B and the status
T the driver to take over the steering. display C.
If the driver does not respond to this, Lane Keep As-
U sist switches to a passive mode (see status display). Vehicles without Adaptive Cruise Control
V Steering intervention on the part of the driver re- (ACC)
activates Lane Keep Assist. The lane markings are only shown on the status dis-
W If Lane Keep Assist must intervene for an extended play C.
X period, the instrument cluster issues an acoustic and
visual warning and prompts the driver to align the Reading off the system states
Y vehicle in the centre of the lane. The table shows the system states of the Lane Keep
Z Assist and their display on the instrument cluster:
138
Lane Keep Assist
139
Lights
A Lights
B
Brief overview Lights
C
D This brief overview does not replace the compre-
hensive descriptions. Safety messages and warn-
E ings, in particular, are not replaced by this brief
F overview.
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
O
Fig. 108: Light control panel
P
What do I want to do? What do I have to do? Where?
Q
Switch on automatic headlights e Press the AUTO button. > p. 141
R The AUTO button lights up red.
S Automatic headlights and the Porsche Dynamic
Light System Plus (PDLS Plus) are switched on.
T
U Switch on parking light e Press button . –
Number plate light, instrument lighting and side
V
lights are switched on.
W
Switch on dipped beams b Ignition switched on. –
X
e Press button .
Y Dipped beams are switched on. Automatic head-
lights, daytime running lights and the Porsche
Z
140
Lights
141
Lights
A Dynamic cornering lights 60 km/h (38 mph). High beam is switched to dipped Porsche Dynamic Light System
B Above a speed of around 5 km/h (3 mph), the dip- beam when the camera detects street lights. Plus (PDLS Plus) with LED-Matrix
ped beam or high beam headlights are swivelled in
C the direction of the curve to illuminate the road more WARNING
Lack of attention when headlights
driving with full beam
clearly, depending on the speed of the vehicle and b Automatic headlights switched on.
D assist
the extent to which the steering wheel is turned. PDLS Plus LED-Matrix headlights also include the
E In spite of full beam assist, it is always the driver’s PDLS Plus functions.
Situational lighting distribution responsibility to manually adapt high beam accord- > Please refer to chapter "Porsche Dynamic Light
F ing to light conditions, visibility and traffic condi- System Plus (PDLS Plus) with LED headlights"
Depending on the country, situational lighting con-
G trol adapts the light distribution of the dipped and tions during driving, for example. The system is not a on page 141.
high-beam headlights to urban, country-road or substitute for careful attention on the part of the
H Dynamic high beam
motorway driving. driver. Manual intervention may be required in the
I following situations:
Adverse weather lights – In unfavourable weather conditions, such as rain,
J
When the fog lights are switched on, the dipped fog, snow, ice, heavy spray.
K beam distribution changes at a speed of less than – On roads where oncoming traffic is partly ob-
approx. 60 km/h (38 mph). The light beam becomes scured, e.g. motorways.
L
wider and reduces glare. – Where there are poorly lit road users, e.g.
M cyclists.
Full beam assist – On narrow bends, steep crests or hollows.
N
– In poorly lit built up areas.
O – Where there are strong reflections e.g. signs. Fig. 110: Windscreen camera
P – Where the windscreen in the camera area is Light sources and other road users can be detected
misted, dirty, icy or covered with stickers. by means of a camera A in the vicinity of the interior
Q
e Drive with extreme care. mirror. Depending on the position of other vehicles,
R e Always pay attention to the traffic situation and the speed and other environmental and traffic con-
the area around the vehicle. ditions, the individual LED segments of the high
S
e If necessary, manually adjust the high beam to
beam headlights are activated or deactivated. The
T beam in the relevant area in front of the vehicle is
Fig. 109: Windscreen camera
the light, visibility and traffic conditions.
low, the rest remains high. This ensures that the en-
U Light sources and other road users can be detected vironment is lit to best effect without dazzling other
V by means of a camera A in the vicinity of the interior Information road users.
mirror. Depending on the position of other vehicles, Dynamic high beam is switched on or off at speeds
W To avoid impairing the detection performance:
the dipped beam headlight is switched to high beam between 30 km/h (20 mph) and 60 km/h (37 mph),
e Do not cover the camera area on the interior depending on the navigation data. Full high beam il-
X headlight and back.
mirror with objects (e.g. stickers). lumination is switched to dipped beam when the
The high beam headlight is available from approxi-
Y e The camera must always be kept free of dirt, ice camera detects street lights.
mately 30 km/h (19 mph) to approximately
and snow.
Z
142
Lights
WARNING
Lack of attention when Passing lights b Dipped beam active during reference run while A
driving with dynamic b No oncoming traffic. stationary.
B
high beam
b Vehicle ahead. Automatic headlight calibration starts automatically
In spite of dynamic high beam, it is always the driv- e Operate the direction indicator for overtaking provided the conditions are right (ambient lighting, C
while driving. good projection surface). The LED segments of the
er’s responsibility to manually adapt high beam ac- headlight are automatically activated and deacti-
D
cording to light conditions, visibility and traffic The area next to the vehicle ahead is illuminated
brightly. This makes it easier to see the road vated repeatedly from right to left during calibration E
conditions during driving, for example. The system is and are detected by the camera A.
not a substitute for careful attention on the part of ahead. F
Calibration is used to check headlight alignment and
the driver. Manual intervention may be required in Passing lights are automatically deactivated
again when the turn signal is deactivated or if does not replace manual headlight adjustment. G
the following situations:
oncoming traffic is detected. H
– In unfavourable weather conditions, such as rain, Operating direction indicator and
fog, snow, ice, heavy spray. I
– On roads where oncoming traffic is partly ob-
Encounter lights high beam stalk
b No vehicle ahead. J
scured, e.g. motorways.
b Oncoming traffic with detected headlights.
– Where there are poorly lit road users, e.g. K
cyclists. The light distribution is briefly changed so that the
– On narrow bends, steep crests or hollows.
lane being driven on is illuminated brightly. This L
draws the direction of vision onto the lane being
– In poorly lit built up areas.
driven on. The driver is less dazzled by the oncoming M
– Where there are strong reflections e.g. signs. traffic. N
– Where the windscreen in the camera area is
misted, dirty, icy or covered with stickers. Signage glare reduction O
e Drive with extreme care. b Dynamic high beam is switched on. P
e Always pay attention to the traffic situation and The glare of reflective traffic signs and other signage
the area around the vehicle. Q
can – particularly when driving with high beams –
e If necessary, manually adjust the high beam to cause the driver to be dazzled. R
the light, visibility and traffic conditions. The signage glare reduction briefly dims individual
S
LED segments of the vehicle's low or high beam
Information headlights in a targeted manner. The driver is T
dazzled less due to reflecting traffic signs and other
To avoid impairing the detection performance: signage. U
e Do not cover the camera area on the interior Fig. 111: Operating direction indicators, high beam and V
mirror with objects (e.g. stickers). Automatic headlight calibration headlight flasher
e The camera must always be kept free of dirt, ice W
b No objects in the immediate vicinity of the 1 Direction indicator/left parking light
and snow. vehicle. 2 Direction indicator/right parking light X
b Vehicle positioned as straight as possible in front
3 High beam/dynamic high beam
4 Headlight flasher Y
of a projection surface, e.g. wall (distance > 5m).
Z
143
Lights
A Operating direction indicators switched to high beam headlight and back. If The dynamic high beam can only be deactivated
B e Push the stalk past pressure point 1 or 2. The high beam activated, the indicator light when the indicator light is on.
direction indicator remains active until the stalk comes on. If the dynamic high beam was deactivated or if the
C is returned to the initial position manually or au- requirements for the dynamic high beam are not
Deactivating
tomatically due to steering wheel movement. met, high beam can be switched on and off
D e Push the stalk once to pressure point 4.
Comfort direction indication manually.
E Full beam assist can only be deactivated when
e Push the stalk once to pressure point 1 or 2. Switching on manually
the indicator light is on.
F The direction indicators flash three times.
If the requirements for full beam assist are not met, e Push the stalk twice to pressure point 3.
G e In order to interrupt comfort direction indication, high beam can be switched on and off manually. The indicator light comes on.
press the stalk in the opposite direction.
H Switching on manually Switching off manually
Switching high beam on and off e Push the stalk twice to pressure point 3. e Push the stalk once to pressure point 4.
I
b Vehicles without PDLS Plus The indicator light comes on. The indicator light goes out.
J – or –
Switching off manually
Full beam assist/dynamic high beam is Operating the headlight flasher
K e Push the stalk once to pressure point 4.
deactivated. e Briefly push the stalk once to pressure point 4.
L The indicator light goes out.
Switching on The indicator light comes on briefly.
M e Push the stalk once to pressure point 3. Activating and deactivating dynamic high
N The indicator light comes on. beam Switching parking light on and off
b Porsche Dynamic Light System Plus (PDLS Plus) b Ignition switched off.
O Switching off
e Press the stalk past pressure point 2 or 1 to
e Push the stalk once to pressure point 4. with LED-Matrix headlights
P b Automatic headlights switched on. switch on the right or left parking light.
The indicator light goes out.
Q b Dynamic high beam is activated. When the parking light is switched on, a mes-
sage appears on the instrument cluster after the
Activating and deactivating full beam assist > Please refer to chapter "Vehicle Settings" on
R ignition is switched off and the door is opened.
page 246.
b Porsche Dynamic Light System Plus (PDLS Plus)
S with LED headlights Activating
T b Automatic headlights switched on. e Push the stalk once to pressure point 3.
b Full beam assist is activated. The indicator light comes on. Depending on
U
> Please refer to chapter "Vehicle Settings" on various factors such as the position of other ve-
V page 246. hicles and speed, the individual LED segments of
W Activating the high beam headlights are activated or deac-
tivated. If high beam is partly or fully activated,
e Push the stalk once to pressure point 3.
X the indicator light comes on.
The indicator light comes on. Depending on
Y different factors, such as the position of other Deactivating
Z vehicles and speed, the dipped beam headlight is e Push the stalk once to pressure point 4.
144
Lights
Switching hazard warning lights Hazard warning lights following an accident NOTICE A
on/off The hazard warning lights are activated automati- B
cally in the event of an accident in which the airbag Abrasion and excessive temperatures can cause
is triggered. damage to the headlights. C
e Do not install any coverings (e. g. stone guards or D
Activating overseas mode films) in the headlight area.
When you cross the border into a country where
E
traffic drives on the other side of the road, the light F
distribution of the headlights must be adapted. The
dipped beam then lights symmetrically and drivers G
of oncoming vehicles are not dazzled. H
Adaptation of the light distribution normally occurs
automatically based on the navigation data. I
After conversion, a message appears in the instru- J
ment cluster every time the ignition is switched on.
K
If conversion does not take place automatically:
L
e CAR e CONTROL e Vehicle settings e
Light and visibility e Exterior light e Inverted M
Fig. 112: Switching hazard warning lights on and off e Readjust headlights on the return journey. N
O
Switching hazard warning lights on and off Changing bulbs P
e Press button in the switch panel. The vehicle lighting as well as the interior lights are
All direction indicators and the button flash. equipped with long-life LEDs. The LEDs cannot be Q
replaced individually.
Deactivating hazard warning lights after R
Removing and installing lamps involves a great deal
emergency braking of effort. S
If the vehicle is travelling at a speed of more than e Always have faulty bulbs and lamps replaced or T
approx. 70 km/h (43 mph) and is braked fully to a repaired by a qualified specialist workshop. Por-
standstill, the hazard warning lights are activated sche recommends a Porsche partner as they U
automatically. The brake lights flash during braking. have trained workshop personnel and the neces- V
e Press the hazard warning light button on the sary parts and tools.
centre console to deactivate the hazard warning W
lights. The hazard warning lights are deactivated
automatically when the vehicle begins to move
X
again. Y
Z
145
Luggage compartment
146
Luggage compartment
147
Luggage compartment
148
Luggage Compartment Lid
149
Luggage Compartment Lid
A Opening luggage compartment lid with driv- Opening luggage compartment lid with Com- Closing luggage compartment lid
er's key fort Access (keyless) 1. Lower the lid and let it fall into the lock. Push the
B
lid closed with the palm of your hand in the area
C of the lock.
D 2. Check that the lid has engaged correctly in the
lock.
E If the lid is not closed properly, a message ap-
F pears on the instrument cluster when the vehicle
is moving.
G
H Performing emergency release of
I luggage compartment lid
If the battery is discharged, the luggage compart-
J ment lid can be opened only with the aid of a donor
K battery.
> Please refer to chapter "Jump-lead Starting" on
L page 129.
M
N Fig. 122: Opening luggage compartment lid with driver's key Fig. 123: Opening luggage compartment lid with Comfort
Access
O 1. Press button .
2. Lift the lid up slightly and release the safety b Vehicles with Comfort Access
P
latch. b Driver's key is located in the front area of the
Q 3. Open the lid completely. vehicle.
When the lid is open, the luggage compartment 1. Place your hand between the Porsche Crest and
R the number plate. Either move your hand in a
light comes on.
S forward and backward movement or make a
swiping action.
T Information
The lid is unlocked.
U When the luggage compartment lid is unlocked us- 2. Lift the lid up slightly and release the safety
ing the driver's key, the vehicle doors are also latch.
V
unlocked. 3. Open the lid completely.
W When the lid is open, the luggage compartment
X light comes on.
Fig. 124: Emergency release of luggage compartment lid –
Y connecting positive terminal
150
Luggage Compartment Lid
1. Use the emergency key to unlock the vehicle at lid is unlocked and the alarm system is A
the door lock. deactivated.
B
2. Remove the plastic cover from the left-hand fuse 7. Disconnect the negative lead first, then the pos-
box. itive lead. C
3. Pull out positive terminal A (red) in the fuse box. 8. Push positive terminal A into the fuse box and fit
D
4. Use the red jump lead to connect the positive the plastic fuse box cover.
terminal of the donor battery to the positive ter- E
minal A in the fuse box.
F
Information G
If the vehicle was locked, the alarm horn from the H
alarm system will sound when the negative terminal I
is connected.
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
Fig. 125: Emergency release of luggage compartment lid – V
connecting negative terminal
W
5. Use the black jump lead to connect the negative
terminal of the donor battery to the joint of the X
door arrester B.
Y
6. Press and hold the button on the driver's key
for approx. 2 seconds. The luggage compartment Z
151
Media
A Media
B
Brief Overview – Media
C
This brief overview does not replace the compre-
D
hensive descriptions. Safety messages and warn-
E ings, in particular, are not replaced by this brief
overview.
F
For information on operating Porsche
G Communication Management (PCM):
H > Please refer to chapter "Porsche Communication
Management (PCM)" on page 175.
I
J
K
Fig. 126: Playing media
L
M What do I want to do? What do I have to do? Where?
Q Find station/track/album (search relates to the e MEDIA e Perform Media Search (see A) e –
R currently selected media source) Enter the desired station/track.
S Select media source/reception range e MEDIA e PLAY e Call up media sources –
T (see B) e Select media source (e.g. DAB/
U FM).
152
Media
E
Deleting a favourite
F
1. MEDIA e FAV
G
2. Select the desired station/track and move up-
H wards from the Favourites display area via drag
I & drop.
– or –
J
If available, select the icon under MEDIA
K e PLAY /LIST in order to delete a pre-
L viously stored favourite from the Favourites
area.
M
N Retrieving program guide
O
Displaying program guide
P b Media source DAB selected.
Q
e MEDIA e LIST e Options e
R Electronic program guide (EPG)
Information on digital programmes is displayed.
S
T Navigating in the programme guide
U b Programme guide displayed.
V e Navigate in the programme guide by swiping
W vertically (scrolling) or using the rotary push
button.
X
e Select Programme to display the details
Y
Z
154
Mirror
155
Mirror
A Folding exterior mirrors in and out Folding exterior mirrors in and out from the Information
outside
B The exterior mirrors will not fold out automatically
The exterior mirrors can be folded in when the ve-
C hicle is locked. after the ignition is switched on if they were folded
in manually beforehand using button D (Fig. 127).
D e Press and hold the button on the driver's key
for at least 1 second.
E In vehicles with Comfort Access: Touch the
proximity sensor on the door handle of the driv- Storing exterior mirror settings
F
er's side for at least 1 second. In vehicles with memory package, individual exterior
G The exterior mirrors fold in. mirror settings can be stored on the memory but-
tons on the driver’s door and on the driver's key.
H Folding exterior mirrors out automatically > Please refer to chapter "Personal Settings" on
I e Switch on ignition. page 169.
The exterior mirrors fold out automatically.
J
Folding exterior mirrors in and out automati-
Switching automatic anti-dazzle
K
cally (depending on equipment) function of exterior mirrors on and
L The automatic folding in and out function of the ex- off
M terior mirrors can be adjusted in the PCM. The exterior mirrors change to anti-dazzle position
Fig. 129: Folding exterior mirrors in and out automatically in synchronisation with the interior
N Activating function
mirror.
O Folding in exterior mirrors manually e CAR e CONTROL e Vehicle e Locking e > Please refer to chapter "Switching automatic
e Swivel the mirror housing diagonally upwards by Fold-in mirrors anti-dazzle function of the interior mirror on and
P hand as far as it will go. off" on page 158.
Q Folding exterior mirrors in automatically
Folding out exterior mirrors manually b Function activated. Swivelling down mirror glass as
R e Swivel the mirror housing diagonally downwards e Lock the vehicle.
S by hand as far as it will go. parking aid
The exterior mirrors fold in automatically.
On vehicles with memory package, the mirror on the
T Folding exterior mirrors in and out electrically Folding exterior mirrors out automatically passenger’s side swivels down slightly to show the
(depending on equipment) b Function activated. kerb area when reverse gear is engaged.
U
b Maximum speed of approx. 50 km/h (30 mph). e Switch on ignition.
V
e Press button D (Fig. 127). The exterior mirrors fold out automatically.
W Both exterior mirrors fold in or out.
X If the electrical folding function fails
e Fold mirror in or out manually.
Y
Z
156
Mirror
The symbol for adjusting the exterior mirror Dimming interior mirror manually A
on the passenger’s side lights up.
B
2. Press button B for adjusting the exterior mirror
on the right-hand side (on a right-hand drive ve- C
hicle press button A ).
D
The mirror glass on the passenger's side swivels
downwards. E
Individually adjusting the position of the lowered F
mirror glass:
G
e Move the exterior mirror glass to the required
position by pressing adjustment button C. H
In vehicles with memory package, this setting is
I
stored on the memory buttons in the driver's door or
on the driver's key. J
For information on retrieving and storing vehicle
K
settings:
Fig. 130: Swivelling down mirror glass as parking aid > Please refer to chapter "Personal Settings" on L
page 169.
M
Swivelling down mirror glass automatically Fig. 131: Dimming interior mirror manually
Downward swivelling of the passenger side mirror Moving mirror glass to its initial position N
The mirror glass swivels back to its initial position: When the mirror is being adjusted, the anti-dazzle
glass can be adjusted in the PCM. O
lever A must point towards the passenger
– after a certain time delay, if the vehicle is shifted
Activating function compartment.
out of reverse gear, or P
e Basic setting – swivel lever towards the passen-
e CAR e CONTROL e Vehicle settings e – immediately, if the vehicle reaches a speed of
ger compartment. Q
Light and visibility e Reversing e Lower mirror more than 15 km/h (9 mph).
e Anti-dazzle position – swivel lever towards the
R
b Ignition switched on. Moving the mirror glass on the passenger’s side to windscreen.
b Reverse gear is engaged. its initial position manually: S
b Function activated. e Press button A for the exterior mirror on the
T
driver’s side.
Swivelling down mirror glass manually U
On vehicles with memory package the mirror glass V
on the passenger's side can be swivelled
W
downwards.
1. Engage reverse gear. X
Y
Z
157
Mirror
C and off
Electrolyte fluid may escape from a broken mirror.
D This fluid causes irritation to the skin and eyes.
E e In the event of contact with the skin or eyes,
F immediately rinse off the electrolyte fluid using
clean water.
G e Seek medical attention from a doctor if
H necessary.
I
NOTICE
J
K Risk of damage to paintwork, leather, plastic com-
ponents and clothing.
L Electrolyte fluid can only be removed while it is still
M wet.
N e Clean affected parts with water.
U
Information
V
The interior mirror does not dim when reverse gear is
W engaged or when interior lighting is switched on.
X
Y Switching off automatic anti-dazzle function
e Press button B.
Z
158
Navigation
Navigation A
B
Brief Overview - Navigation
C
This brief overview does not replace the compre- D
hensive descriptions. Safety messages and warn-
ings, in particular, are not replaced by this brief E
overview. F
For information on operating Porsche
G
Communication Management (PCM):
> Please refer to chapter "Porsche Communication H
Management (PCM)" on page 175.
I
J
Fig. 133: Entering/searching for a destination Fig. 134: Search options on the keyboard K
What do I want to do? What do I have to do? Where? L
M
Find a destination/enter a destination address e Select NAV e in the header (see A). –
– or – N
NAV e DEST e Destination input (see O
A)
– Voice input (see E) P
– Integrated search: search in PCM memory and Q
online content (see F)
– Online search (availability dependent on coun- R
try)1: Internet search (see G) S
T
Select previous destination e NAV e DEST / FAV e Recent –
destinations (see B) /My Destinations U
V
Enter POI e NAV e DEST e Points of interest (see –
C) W
X
Y
Z
1. Prerequisite: A data connection is established. Online navigation and Porsche Connect services activated.
159
Navigation
U Risk of accident through regulations always apply. The driver is always re- Risk of accident owing to
WARNING WARNING
disregarding road traffic sponsible for road safety. system-related inaccur-
V
laws acies and malfunctions
e Always pay attention to the traffic situation.
W e Adapt your speed and driving style to the visibil-
If a recommended driving instruction contradicts the Incorrect directions and malfunctions cannot be
X road traffic laws in force, the country-specific traffic ity, weather, road and traffic conditions. ruled out during satellite-based navigation. The
Y
Z
1. Data connection established. Porsche Connect services and Online navigation services are activated.
160
Navigation
driver is always responsible for driving the vehicle. 1. NAV e FAV e My Destinations Information A
e Always pay attention to the terrain.
2. My Destinations e Stored tours e Select – Up to three destinations are created and up to B
desired tour. three routes are available for each destination. C
Accepting destination from map Suggested routes are prioritised according to
D
Editing a tour how frequently an identical route is travelled.
1. Select NAV e MAP . You can reorganise the stopovers at a later time. – The traffic situation for available smart routes is E
displayed depending on the current vehicle
2. Touch the destination on the map for longer. b Tour started. F
position.
3. Select to start route guidance. e Under NAV e DEST e Options e Edit – The PCM identifies whether the route is travelled G
route, then press and hold the relevant stopover during the week or at the weekend. Recorded
and move it to the desired position (drag & smart routes are only displayed at the appropri- H
Planning a tour (entering a drop). ate time - either at the weekend or on weekdays. I
stopover) – Opening Smart routing stops active route
guidance. J
A tour consists of one destination and one to eight Smart routing K
stopovers. A smart route is created automatically as soon as an
identical route is travelled twice. Accessing smart routing L
Entering and starting a tour
b Smart routing activated. M
Activating smart routing
1. NAV e Enter destination e Start route
1. NAV e MAP N
guidance . 1. NAV e Options e Navigation settings
2. Select at the bottom right of the map O
2. Options e Edit route e Add stopover . 2. Under Smart routing, activate the function
Smart routing. 3. Select the desired smart route from the list of P
3. Enter or select a stopover. suggestions.
The symbol is displayed at the bottom Q
4. Add as stopover e Start tour. right of the map. 4. Select Start . R
Saving a tour S
Deleting Smart routing
b Tour started. T
Stored smart routes remain stored after the function
e Options e Edit route e Options e Save is deactivated and must be deleted. U
tour e NAV e MAP e Options e Navigation V
settings e Smart routing
Retrieving a tour W
b Tour is stored. X
Y
Z
161
Navigation
A Configuring map content The number displayed in the TRAFFIC icon Displaying and configuring the map display
indicates the number of traffic notices on the 1. Select the map view in the Car & Info display on
B 1. NAV e MAP e (in the header) selected route. the instrument cluster.
C 2. Activate/deactivate the desired map content 2. Select traffic notice. > Please refer to chapter "D – Car & Info dis-
D (availability dependent on country): – or – play" on page 120.
Select Show all traffic notices to display all 2. Select the desired view option via the multi-
E – 3D map: Show or hide 3D map view (otherwise function steering wheel:
traffic notices.
2D view).
F – Man. zoom: Adjust the zoom factor for the map
– Auto zoom: Activate or deactivate Auto zoom display.
G function in the map. Avoiding traffic disruptions
– Auto zoom: The map scale is adjusted
– Satellite map: Show or hide satellite view on the Traffic disruptions can be automatically avoided or automatically.
H map. displayed in route guidance.
– 3D map: Three-dimensional map display.
I – Weather1: Show or hide weather information on
the map. e Activate NAV e Options e Route – North up: North is always at the top of the map.
J
– Display points of interest: Show or hide points of options e Dynamic reroute/Refer to traffic – Map info: If no map view is selected in the Car &
notices. Info display on the instrument cluster, the map is
K interest on the map.
automatically displayed in the event of a naviga-
– Compass: Show or hide compass on the map. The radio station or online content providers are re- tion event.
L
sponsible for traffic notices. For that reason, no li- – Arrow info: If the Navigation menu is not se-
M Displaying traffic information ability can be accepted for the completeness and lected in the Speed & Assist display on the in-
correctness of the information. strument cluster, the menu is displayed
N
Displaying traffic information on the map1 automatically in the case of a navigation event.
O You can display the following traffic information on Activating intelligent detour
the current location or on the selected route on the b Route guidance active. Displaying navigation information in the in-
P
map: strument cluster
Q e Activate NAV e Options e Intelligent
– Hatched areas: Indication of the length of the e Select the Navigation menu in the Speed & As-
traffic disruption. detour.
R sist display in the instrument cluster.
The section of the route ahead is avoided.
– Coloured warning symbols: Imminent traffic > Please refer to chapter "A - Speed & Assist
S disruption on the selected route. If route guid- display" on page 120.
T ance is not active, all current traffic disruptions Displaying map view and naviga-
tion information on the instrument Changing navigation settings
are highlighted in colour.
U – Greyed-out warning symbols: Traffic disruption
V which is not on the selected route. cluster e NAV e Options e Navigation settings e
For information on operating the instrument cluster: Select the desired setting.
W Displaying list of traffic information > Please refer to chapter "Operating the instru-
X ment cluster" on page 122.
1. NAV e TRAFFIC
Y
Z
1. Prerequisite: A data connection is established. Porsche Connect services activated.
162
Navigation
Toll devices A
B
C
D
E
F
G
Fig. 135: Attaching toll devices
H
Attach the toll device at the marked position on the
inside of the windscreen in order to guarantee opti-
I
mum reception. J
K
L
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
W
X
Y
Z
163
Night View Assist
A Night View Assist An impending collision or driving dangerously close cluster in the vehicle speed range up to 250 km/h
past persons will trigger a warning within the limi- (156 mph).
B WARNING
Lack of attention and
tations of the system limits. In this case, the system
failure to detect objects
C warns the driver visually and audibly. On vehicles
via Night View Assist with Porsche Dynamic Light System Plus, the en-
D dangered person is flashed at in order to enhance
Night View Assist is a support system and cannot
E recognition.
warn of an impending collision under all circum-
Prior to an impending collision with wild animals
F stances. Risk of accident!
outside urban areas, a warning is also issued within
Responsibility for timely braking and appropriate the limitations of the system. In this case, the sys-
G
vehicle lighting for the situation always lies with the tem warns the driver visually and audibly.
H driver.
I e Drive with extreme care.
e Always pay attention to the traffic situation and
J the area around the vehicle.
K
Night View Assist re-
L CAUTION
stricted or not available
M Shocks or damage to the bumper, e.g. through
N parking bumps, can move the sensors. This may im- Fig. 137: Pedestrian warning on the instrument cluster.
pair performance of the system. The pedestrian warning is output if a pedestrian is
O
e Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Porsche standing or moving onto the driving lane. On vehicles
P recommends a Porsche partner as they have with LED-Matrix headlights, the endangered person
trained workshop personnel and the necessary is flashed at in order to enhance recognition. In the
Q event of this warning, it may still be possible to pre-
parts and tools.
R vent a collision through the driver avoiding the pe-
The thermal imaging camera of the Night View As- destrian or braking sharply. The warning time varies
S sist in the front of the vehicle provides a thermal according to the traffic situation and the driver's
T image of the surroundings, which can be displayed in Fig. 136: Night View Assist thermal image behaviour.
the Car & Info display in the instrument cluster. The The Porsche Night View Assist has the following
U system can detect persons and animals beyond the functions: Animal warning
area illuminated by the headlights and highlight
V – Display of the thermal image The animal warning reacts to hazards caused by wild
these in the camera image. animals, e.g. deer outside built-up areas. The animal
– Pedestrian and animal warning
W Because the thermal imaging camera is only sensi- warning is triggered if an animal is located in the
tive in the heat radiation range, the image in the
X Pedestrian warning projected driving lane or is in dangerously close
camera may differ significantly from the image as proximity. In urban areas, the animal warning is au-
If the system detects a possible collision with a pe-
Y perceived by the human eye. Night View Assist de- tomatically deactivated in order to prevent false
tects persons and animals when it is sufficiently dark destrian, it can warn the driver by means of a warn-
Z ing tone and an appropriate display in the instrument warnings caused e.g. through leashed dogs.
and at an ambient temperature of under 28 °C.
164
Night View Assist
165
ParkAssist
166
ParkAssist
Colour Distance at Distance at reversing camera image does not show the complete the cameras, obstacles or markings as well as the A
front rear area behind the vehicle. exact position of the vehicle are detected. When
B
e Always pay attention to the entire vehicle Surround View is active, the courtesy lighting is
Red < 40 cm < 40 cm surroundings. switched on for better illumination. C
e Make sure that no persons, animals, obstacles or D
Red with con- < 30 cm < 30 cm vehicles are within the red area of the reversing
Activating Surround View
tinuous tone camera image. Automatically E
b ParkAssist activated.
For information on operating Porsche F
Manually
Communication Management (PCM): Activating the reversing camera G
> Please refer to chapter "Porsche Communication Automatically e ASSIST e ParkAssist
Management (PCM)" on page 175. H
b Ignition is switched on and reverse gear Select the desired view via the relevant symbol, e.g.
engaged. Rear). The symbol for the active view is highlighted I
Deactivating ParkAssist – or – in red. J
b Vehicle rolling backwards has been detected.
Deactivating automatically Symbol View K
b P button on the selector lever is activated. Manually
L
e ASSIST e ParkAssist Parking (change front
Enabling/disabling automatic activation and rear view by M
tapping)
e ASSIST e e Assistance system set- Automatically deactivating reversing camera N
tings e ParkAssist b Speed is higher than 15 km/h (9 mph). Panorama (change O
– or – front and rear view by
P
Adjusting ParkAssist volume b P button on the selector lever is activated. tapping)
Q
e ASSIST e e Assistance system set- Surround View Side
tings e ParkAssist R
Danger of injury
WARNING S
Reversing camera Information
T
The objects detected by the camera appear dis-
The reversing camera facilitates monitoring of the In addition to the camera image, guide lines are U
torted. Many of the screen windows do not show the
area behind the vehicle during parking manoeuvres. superimposed on the front and rear camera views.
entire area around the vehicle. V
The reversing camera image is displayed on the These guide lines indicate the direction the vehicle
PCM. e Always pay attention to the entire vehicle can follow with the steering wheel in the current
surroundings. W
Danger of injury position. The guide lines change as the position of
WARNING e Make sure that no persons, animals, obstacles or the front wheels changes. X
vehicles are within the manoeuvring area.
Y
The objects shown by the camera appear distorted.
Surround View provides a birds' eye view of the ve-
The red mark represents the rear of the vehicle. The Z
hicle and covers the area around the vehicle. Using
167
ParkAssist
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
W
X
Y
Z
168
Personal Settings
169
Personal Settings
170
Porsche Active Safe (warning and brake assist)
Porsche Active Safe (warning 85 km/h (53 mph). It can react to vehicles up to a When Porsche Active Safe is switched off, the dis- A
and brake assist) speed of 250 km/h (156 mph).
The system does not respond to animals, crossing
play appears on the instrument cluster.
B
Porsche Active Safe (PAS - warning and brake as- Porsche Active Safe is activated automatically when
vehicles, oncoming vehicles and objects such as C
sist) can initiate measures to protect occupants and the ignition is switched on.
bars, fences and rail vehicles.
other road users in certain dangerous situations. D
The function is not available:
Porsche Active Safe includes the following
– When reversing. Distance warning E
functions1: If Porsche Active Safe detects a safety hazard due to
– If the brake lights are defective. F
– Distance warning (depending on equipment) following too close, the driver is warned through the
– If the PSM malfunctions and PSM is switched
– Warning and braking functions symbol on the instrument cluster1. G
off.
– Preventive occupant protection functions (de- Detection can take place in a vehicle speed range
– If the airbag control unit malfunctions. H
pending on equipment) from approx. 65 – 250 km/h (40 – 156 mph).
The function may be restricted, or unavailable: I
The camera behind the windscreen captures the
– Up to 10 seconds after switching on the ignition. Setting the distance warning
front vehicle environment. An imminent frontal col- J
lision with road users can be detected. The system – If the seat belts are not fastened.
warns the driver visually, acoustically and if neces- – In sharp bends. e ASSIST e e Assistance system set- K
sary through a braking jolt. Where required, the sys- – In the presence of reflective objects such as tings e Porsche Active Safe
guardrails or when entering a tunnel. L
tem can support the driver's braking or initiate
partial or full deceleration in order to reduce the – In heavy rain, snow, fog and ice. M
collision speed or prevent the collision in some – In the event of damage to the windscreen.
Warning and braking functions
circumstances. The warning and braking functions can be activated N
– If the windscreen is dirty.
in three stages. O
System limitations – Collision warning (visual and acoustic)
Switching Porsche Active Safe – Acute warning (brake pressure) P
The system can warn of impending front collisions
within the system limits and initiate appropriate on/off – Automatic braking and brake assistance Q
braking manoeuvres1. Not all road users and dan- NOTICE
gerous situations can be recognised correctly and in R
time. S
e Switch off Porsche Active Safe in the following
The lateral vehicle areas and the rear area are not
monitored.
situations: T
– When towing.
In complex driving situations, the system can give U
unwanted warnings and perform unwanted brake – When driving off public roads.
interventions. – When transporting, e.g. on a car transporter, V
The system is available above walking speed and can train or ship. W
react to pedestrians up to a speed of
X
e ASSIST e Porsche Active Safe
Y
Z
1. Not available in some country versions.
171
Porsche Active Safe (warning and brake assist)
A Collision warning With the braking jolt, the system draws attention to Preventive occupant protection
B
the increasing danger of collision. function
In the event of this warning, it may still be possible
C to prevent a collision through the driver avoiding the Seat belt system optimisation
pedestrian or braking sharply.
D When driving off, the front seat belts are gently
tightened in order to ensure an optimal position with
E Automatic braking and brake assistance1 regard to the occupants. Activation is performed
If the driver does not respond to the acute warning when reaching a driving speed of approx. 30 km/h
F
or does not brake sufficiently, the warning and brake (20 mph) or when the seat belts are fastened again.
G assist, supports the driver during braking or brakes
the vehicle to a standstill with progressively in- Preconditioning of the seat belt and passen-
H creasing braking force. ger compartment
I Additionally, a warning tone is emitted and a symbol If a potentially hazardous accident situation is de-
appears in the instrument cluster. tected, the warning and brake assist can initiate
J
By reducing the vehicle speed, the consequences of measures to prepare for a possible collision in order
K a possible accident are mitigated. to support the effectiveness of the passive passen-
L ger protection systems. For this purpose, depending
Information on the situation, the front seat belts are reversibly
M pretensioned, windows are opened and (depending
Fig. 142: Collision warning on the instrument cluster Automatic braking interventions can be aborted with
N on equipment) the roof system is closed and the
The collision warning warns the driver by means of a the following measures: adaptive front seat side bolsters are inflated.
O warning tone and a symbol on the instrument e Pressing the brake pedal Within the system limits, the preventive occupant
cluster. e Fully depress the accelerator pedal protection measures can be activated both during
P
e steer actively emergency braking initiated by the driver above a
Q Setting the collision warning speed of approx. 30 km/h (20 mph) or through an
The collision warning can be switched off and on. automatic brake intervention initiated by the vehicle.
R Information
The warning time can also be set. As soon as the collision hazard has passed and a
S Once the vehicle has reached a standstill, it is not stable driving condition is achieved, the precondi-
e ASSIST e e Assistance system set- held permanently by the brake system. tioning measures are ended and existing seat belt
T tings e Porsche Active Safe e If necessary, actuate the brake and resume con- tension is released again.
U trol of the vehicle.
Acute warning System limitations
V
If the driver does not respond to the collision warn- In the case of repeated activation (e.g. in the context
W ing, a braking jolt is performed n addition to the of driver safety training), the belt tension increases
warning tone and the symbol on the instrument progressively so that it may no longer be possible to
X reliably release the belt tensioning. In this case,
cluster.
Y
Z
1. Not available in some country versions.
172
Porsche Active Safe (warning and brake assist)
173
Porsche Active Suspension Management (PASM)
S Information
T
The last selected chassis setup is stored in the
U memory after the ignition is switched off.
V
W Responding to warning message
PASM faults are displayed on the instrument cluster.
X > Please refer to chapter "Warning and Information
Y Messages" on page 255.
174
Porsche Communication Management (PCM)
Porsche Communication A
Management (PCM) B
C
Brief Overview – PCM
D
This brief overview does not replace the complete
information provided in this section.
E
Safety messages and warnings, in particular, are not F
replaced by this brief overview. G
H
I
J
Fig. 144: Volume control and rotary push button Fig. 145: Areas of the touch display
K
What do I want to do? What do I have to do? Where?
L
Switch on the PCM e Switch on ignition or press volume control A. – M
Switch off the PCM e Switch off ignition or press and hold volume – N
control A.
O
Adjust the volume e Turn volume control A. Mute: Briefly press vol- – P
ume control A.
Q
Operate the PCM e Operate the PCM with rotary push button B. > p. 178
R
Use content from the main and sub-menus e Use menu area C and interaction area E. > p. 177 S
Use context-dependent search function and op- e Use status area D. > p. 178 T
tions, display connection and status symbols, nav- U
igate back
V
Open home screen e Select status area D > p. 177
. W
Open and use Info Widget e Open and use the Info Widget F in all menus. > p. 178 X
Y
Configure home screen/Info widget e e Options e Configure Home/Configure > p. 180
Z
Info Widget
175
Porsche Communication Management (PCM)
176
Porsche Communication Management (PCM)
177
Porsche Communication Management (PCM)
A G – Options and most important settings for control of the vehicle. D - Vertical swipe (scroll and switch)
B
each menu item e Only operate these components while driving if Swipe the touchscreen vertically with one finger.
the traffic situation allows you to do so safely. Example: Manually scroll through lists or change Info
C H - Connection and status symbols e In case of doubt, safely pull out of traffic and only widget.
E.g. Display of various functions and the temperature carry out extensive operations and settings while
D
or time. Tap to open the quick selection. the vehicle is stationary. E - Vertical swipe (switch)
E Swipe the touchscreen vertically using two fingers
I - Info widget to tilt the map in the Navigation main menu.
F
When is opened, the factory set and individually Operating the touch display
G set functions are displayed. Swipe vertically to F - Zoom
H change Info widget. Move two fingers apart or closer together. Tapping
Content from different categories can be individually the touch display twice zooms in on that section.
I grouped in tiles. A tile contains either a direct jump
J to the relevant menu or direct access to a function. Operating PCM with rotary push
K
Various layouts can be configured.Please refer to
chapter "Home screen and Info widget" on
button and buttons
L page 180.
M
Important information on
N operation Fig. 147: Operating the touch display
O The Porsche Communication Management (PCM) is
the central control unit. To protect the battery, the A - Touch (select)
P PCM switches off automatically a few minutes after Briefly tap the touch display with your finger. Exam-
Q the ignition is switched off. ple: Select a function or check/uncheck a box.
For safety reasons, some functions are only available Fig. 148: Operating the rotary push button
R when the vehicle is stationary. B - Long press e Turn the rotary push button A until the desired
S Setting and operating Touch the touch display with your finger for longer. function is highlighted.
WARNING
T while driving Example: Save station as a favourite in the Media e Press the rotary push button A to activate the
main menu. highlighted function.
U Setting and operating the multi-function steering e Use button B to go back one level.
V wheel, infotainment system, etc. while driving may C - Horizontal swipe e Use button OPT C to call up the most important
distract you from the traffic situation. You may lose Swipe the touchscreen horizontally with your finger. settings for each menu item
W Example: Scroll favourites horizontally.
X Opening menus
Y Opening main menu
Z e Select menu in the touch display (e.g. NAV ).
178
Porsche Communication Management (PCM)
179
Porsche Communication Management (PCM)
A Entry via voice control Deleting tiles in Home screen Notes on interfaces and externally
B Text and numbers can also be entered using voice
e e Options e Activate delete mode
connected devices
control (e.g. for dialling a phone number or entering a – If a storage device contains a large number of
C navigation destination). files, folders or playlists, it may take longer to
> Please refer to chapter "Voice Control" on Configuring Info widget load media tracks for the first time.
D
page 248.
– Audio files are automatically displayed with
E 1. e Options e Configure Info Widget
stored additional information (e.g. artist, title, al-
F Home screen and Info widget 2. Select the desired category, hold and drag any bum cover) during playback. If this information is
tile in the left-hand layout by drag & drop. not available on the medium in question, an
G available Internet database is used. Despite this,
3. Swipe in the tile to select the desired display certain additional information may not be
H contents. displayed.
I 4. If you wish to remove a tile from the left-hand – Do not use USB extension cables or adapters.
J layout, drag the relevant tile upwards using These impair the functionality.
drag & drop or replace it with another tile. – USB hubs are not supported.
K – Porsche will not assume any liability for damaged
Select Switch layout to configure the Info widget
L layout. or lost files or media.
Fig. 151: Configuring Home screen Technical data on supported media and file formats:
M
Information > Please refer to chapter "Porsche Communication
N Configuring Home screen Management (PCM)" on page 175.
A tile can also be moved to any other tile (drag &
O 1. e Options e Configure Home drop).
P
Ports
2. Select the desired category, hold and drag any
Q tile in the left-hand layout by drag & drop. Deleting tiles in Info widget Using ports in the armrest
R 3. Swipe in the tile to select the desired display e e Options e Configure Info Widget e
contents.
S Options e Activate delete mode
4. If you wish to remove a tile from the left-hand
T layout, drag the relevant tile upwards using
U drag & drop or replace it with another tile. Opening manual in PCM
b The vehicle is stationary.
V Select Switch layout to configure the home screen
layout.
e CAR e CONTROL e Drivers's Manual
W
X Information Fig. 152: Ports in the armrest
A SIM card reader
Y A tile can also be moved to any other tile (drag &
B SD card reader
drop).
Z C USB ports
180
Porsche Communication Management (PCM)
181
Porsche Connect
A Porsche Connect Information about the booked data package is b. Select Store PIN.
Various use options are available depending on displayed in some markets.
B 3. Confirm the prompt for establishing the data
model, country and equipment. The features de- connection.
C scribed here are therefore not available in all models,
countries and equipment versions.
Establishing data connection via The data connection is established.
D external SIM card 4. To remove the external SIM card, press on the
Depending on the country, data connection can be
E established via the embedded SIM card, an external An inserted external SIM card deactivates the func- inserted card and remove it.
SIM card or an external WiFi hotspot. The currently tion of the embedded SIM card (availability depend-
F
active data connection is shown in the status line of ent on country). Additional costs may be incurred for
Information
G the PCM and in the device manager. the data connection (e.g. due to data roaming).
> Please refer to chapter "Porsche Communication If a data connection cannot be established, check
H NOTICE
Management (PCM)" on page 175. the following:
I > Please refer to chapter "Device Manager" on – PCM phone is switched on.
page 96. If you are using a SIM card adapter, the SIM card – External SIM card has sufficient data volume and
J may fall out of the adapter due to vibrations and is inserted correctly.
K Establishing data connection via components of the card may get stuck in the drive. – External SIM card is not damaged and is working
e Do not use adapters for SIM cards. properly.
L embedded SIM card (availability – APN settings (Internet access) are correct. The
M dependent on country) APN settings can be checked by contacting the
b The SIM card reader is empty. network operator.
N
b PCM phone switched on (SET e Porsche – Abroad: Data roaming is allowed on the external
O Connect e Switch on telephone function). SIM card and enabled in the PCM.
P The data connection is established immediately – The vehicle is in an area with sufficient network
when the ignition is switched on. reception (not a coverage blackspot).
Q e Restart the PCM if necessary.
R Information
Fig. 153: SIM card in the armrest
S If a data connection cannot be established, check Selecting access point for external SIM card
b PCM phone switched on (SET e Porsche If several access points are available, the message
the following:
T Connect e Switch on telephone function). Several access points (APN) are available. Please
– PCM phone is switched on.
U – The vehicle is in an area with sufficient network 1. Insert external SIM card B (mini-SIM, dimen- select one appears. A list of available access points
reception (not a coverage blackspot). sions: 25 x 15 mm). The missing corner must (APNs) is displayed.
V
e Restart the PCM if necessary. be at the front left with the chip facing 1. Select the desired access point (APN).
W downwards.
2. If there is no access point configured, contact
X 2. SIM card with PIN:
Displaying data packages the mobile phone provider to obtain the APN
Y a. If necessary, enter the PIN for the external settings. To configure the APN settings, select
e APPS e Data packages SIM card and confirm with OK.
Z or (depending on the connection
182
Porsche Connect
status) e Options e Data Connections e WiFi access data of the PCM (device name and – Online voice search as well as dictating A
Reset access point configuration in the header. WiFi password) is displayed. messages.
B
2. Enter the WiFi access data of the PCM into the
Using services in the APPS menu C
Establishing data connection via WiFi settings on the device.
an external WiFi hotspot (avail- A connection is established to the PCM's wire- e Select APPS . D
less Internet access.
ability dependent on country) Available services are displayed. E
b The SIM card reader is empty. F
b Vehicles with embedded SIM card (availability Using Porsche Connect Logging Porsche Connect user (Porsche ID)
dependent on country): PCM phone is switched A data connection is required in order to use Porsche into PCM G
Connect services.
off (SET e Porsche Connect e Switch off The Porsche ID is linked to the PCM using a pairing H
telephone function). > Please refer to chapter "Porsche Connect" on code. This is required for using some Connect serv-
page 182. ices in order to retrieve personal settings from My I
1. Select or in the header (depending on Porsche. J
the connection status) e Options e WiFi e Information 1. APPS e Options e Porsche ID settings e K
Search for WiFi hotspot More information about Porsche Connect (help vid- Link new Porsche ID
L
2. Select a WiFi hotspot (e.g. public hotspot or the eos, Porsche Connect operating instructions and 2. Enter the pairing code that is displayed after
mobile phone’s personal hotspot) and enter questions & answers) can be found at www.porsche. you have successfully activated the services M
WiFi access data in the PCM. When entering com/connect and in the "Good to know" app (avail- under My Porsche.
ability dependent on country).
N
the data, pay attention to upper and lower case.
User is logged in and the symbol appears in
A connection is established to the external WiFi O
the header.
hotspot. P
Activating Porsche Connect services
Before starting to use the Porsche Connect services Porsche Connect Managing user (Porsche ID) Q
Activating the PCM WiFi hotspot for the first time, they must be activated. in PCM
e Activate Porsche Connect Services under www. b A Porsche Connect user created and registered.
R
(wireless Internet access)
Up to eight WIFi devices can be connected to the porsche.com/connect. S
vehicle hotspot. e APPS e Options e Porsche ID settings e
Using services in the navigation system and Select the desired action: T
b Data connection successfully established via the
embedded SIM card or external SIM card.
voice control system U
– Link ID
b Data connection via embedded SIM card (avail- – Online search function for entering navigation
– Remove V
ability dependent on country): relevant data plan destinations as well as loading portal POIs and
– Settings
booked. other POI categories from My Porsche. W
– Porsche ID logout: The currently logged in user is
– Additional map display.
logged out. X
1. Select or in the header (depending on – Realtime traffic provides information on acci-
the connection status) e Options e Vehicle dents, roadworks, traffic flow information and Y
hotspot. other incidents from the Internet.
Z
183
Porsche Connect
A Displaying service overview Changing Porsche Connect vehicle can be transmitted in the event of a break-
B e APPS e Options e Service information
settings down or emergency call as well as theft.
e Please inform all persons using the vehicle that
C Information about the services purchased and e SET e Porsche Connect e Select the de- communication may be disabled.
contract duration is displayed. sired setting:
D
E – Porsche ID settings
Using Porsche apps
– Remote access authorisation: Prerequisite for
F > Please refer to chapter "Apps" on page 41. using service control programmes (My Porsche,
G Porsche Connect App or Porsche Car Connect
Information App (available depending on country)) and acti-
H vating private mode.
– The Porsche Connect services (including the Car
I – Activate or deactivate Private mode globally or
Connect services, but not the Safety and Secur-
for individual services.
J ity services) offer a free inclusive period, which
Please refer to chapter "Private mode" on
varies in length for each services package and
page 184.
K country, but is always at least 3 months. Further
– Switch on telephone function/Switch off
information about the free inclusive periods as
L telephone function: Switch PCM phone on or off.
well as subsequent costs and information about
M the availability of individual services for your
country is available online at www.porsche.com/ Private mode
N connect or from your Porsche partner. Communication between the vehicle and the
O – Depending on the country, the Porsche Connect Porsche Connect App as well as My Porsche is sup-
Services can be used via the integrated SIM or pressed when privacy mode is active. No vehicle-
P via a data-enabled, external SIM card. A separate, specific information is transmitted. This means that
Q fee-based contract with a mobile phone provider no vehicle settings can be configured using the app
is required for the external SIM card. or My Porsche.
R – You may incur additional charges when receiving Activating private mode
S data packages from the Internet, depending on
your mobile phone tariff and whether you are b Remote access authorisation issued (SET e
T abroad. A flat-rate data plan is recommended. Porsche Connect e Remote access
authorisation).
U – The availability, scope and provider of the serv-
ices may vary depending on the country, model
V e SET e Porsche Connect e Private mode
year, device and tariff.
W > Please refer to chapter "Porsche Connect App"
on page 41.
X If there is no active contract for the vehicle, the Por-
Y sche Connect menu item is greyed out. Despite ac-
tivated private mode, location information for the
Z
184
Porsche Stability Management (PSM)
Porsche Stability Automatic Brake Differential (ABD) The PSM OFF warning light on the instrument A
Management (PSM) If one wheel of a driven axle starts to spin, it is cluster comes on. The button lights up red.
A message stating that PSM Sport is activated
B
braked so that the other wheel on the same axle can
Porsche Stability Management (PSM) is an active
be driven. appears on the instrument cluster. C
control system for stabilising the vehicle in extreme
driving situations. It is automatically enabled when D
the engine starts. PSM makes use of both the Auto-
Anti-slip Regulation (ASR) Switching PSM off
matic Brake Differential (ABD) and Anti-slip Regula- The Anti-slip Regulation system prevents the wheels E
tion (ASR) systems, as well as the functions of the from spinning by adjusting the engine power, there- F
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) and engine drag tor- by ensuring good lane-holding ability and stable
que control system (MSR). handling. G
Loss of control over the H
WARNING Engine drag torque control (MSR)
vehicle I
In conditions of excessive slip, the engine drag tor-
Risk of accidents due to inappropriate speed cannot que control system prevents all driven wheels from J
be reduced by PSM. locking up when the vehicle is overrunning. This is
also the case for downshifts on a slippery road. K
The increased safety that is provided should not in-
duce you to take greater risks with your safety. The L
Steering torque pulse
limits set by the physics of driving cannot be over-
The steering torque pulse provides the driver with M
come, even with PSM.
steering assistance when braking on road surfaces
e Despite the advantages of PSM, the driver is re- with differing friction values.
N
sponsible for adapting his or her driving style and Additional steering forces also assist the driver dur- O
manoeuvres in line with road and weather con- ing countersteering.
ditions, as well as the traffic situation. P
Activating PSM Sport Fig. 154: PSM OFF button in the switch panel Q
The events below inform the driver of PSM control
operations: b Vehicles with Sport Chrono package WARNING
No PSM support R
– PSM warning light flashes on the instrument During PSM Sport operation, the system switches to
S
cluster. a particular sporty mode. When PSM is switched off, PSM support is no longer
– Hydraulic noises can be heard. Limited PSM support provided in critical driving situations outside the ABS
T
WARNING
– The vehicle decelerates and steering-wheel control range. U
forces are altered as PSM controls the brakes.
In PSM Sport mode, PSM support is limited in crit- e PSM should always be switched on during "nor- V
– Engine power is reduced. mal" driving.
ical driving situations outside the ABS control range.
– The brake pedal pulsates and its position is W
changed during braking. To achieve full vehicle e PSM Sport should always be switched off during e Briefly press the button (vehicles with Sport
deceleration, the foot pressure must be in- "normal" driving. Chrono package: press the button for at least X
creased after the brake pedal starts to pulsate. 2 seconds). Y
e Press the button briefly.
PSM is switched off after a short delay.
Z
185
Porsche Stability Management (PSM)
A The PSM OFF warning light on the instrument ABS brake system (Anti-lock A pulsating brake pedal and a "juddering noise" alert
B
cluster comes on. The button lights up red. Brake System) the driver to adapt his or her driving speed to the
A warning message appears on the instrument road conditions.
C cluster indicating that PSM is switched off. Loss of control over the Full braking is necessary:
WARNING
vehicle e Fully depress the brake pedal during the entire
D
Information ABS does not reduce the risk of accidents owing to braking operation, despite the pulsing pedal. Do
E an inappropriate driving speed. not reduce the braking pressure.
When you brake in the ABS control range, the vehicle
F is stabilised even when PSM is switched off. One- The increased safety provided should not induce you Responding to warning message
sided spinning of the wheels is prevented, even with to take greater risks with your safety. The limits set
G For information on the ABS warning light :
PSM switched off. by the laws of driving physics cannot be overcome,
H even with ABS. > Please refer to chapter "Warning and Information
Messages" on page 255.
I However, it may be advantageous to switch off PSM e Despite the advantages of ABS, the driver is re-
temporarily in exceptional situations: sponsible for adapting his or her driving style and
J – On loose ground and deep snow. manoeuvres in line with road and weather con- Multi-collision braking
K – When "rocking the vehicle free". ditions, as well as the traffic situation. During an accident, multi-collision braking can help
If the slide/tilt roof is open and the PSM is switched the driver reduce the risk of skidding and further
L ABS ensures: collisions during the accident through automatically
off, the PSM is switched on again when a speed of
– Full steering control: The vehicle remains initiated braking.
M approx. 160 km/h (100 mph) is exceeded.
steerable.
N – Good driving stability: no skidding by blocking Prerequisites
Information wheels. Multi-collision braking only works:
O
When PSM Sport mode is active, it is only possible – Optimal braking distance: Shorter stopping dis- – in the event of front, side and rear-end collisions.
P to switch to PSM OFF mode if the PSM was acti- tances in most cases. – if the airbag control unit detects a corresponding
Q vated beforehand. – Prevention of wheel locking: No flat spots on the activation threshold during an accident.
tyres. – if an accident occurs when the vehicle is travel-
R ling at a speed of more than approx. 10 km/h (
S Switching PSM back on Position 6 mph).
e Press button . The decisive advantage of ABS lies in the driving
T stability and manoeuvrability of the vehicle in haz-
PSM is active immediately. Information
U ardous situations.
The PSM OFF warning light in the instrument ABS prevents the wheels from locking during full PSM automatically brakes the vehicle provided the
V cluster and the red lighting of the button go braking on virtually all road surfaces until just before hydraulic brake system PSM, and the electrical sys-
out. the vehicles come to a standstill. tem are not damaged and are still working after the
W A message appears on the instrument cluster ABS begins to take control as soon as one wheel accident.
X indicating that PSM is switched on. shows a tendency to lock.
Y This controlled braking process is comparable with
extremely rapid cadence braking.
Z
186
Porsche Stability Management (PSM)
Exceptional conditions A
The following activities prevent automatic braking in B
the event of an accident:
– When the driver noticeably presses on the ac- C
celerator pedal. D
– When the braking pressure exerted by the driver
on the brake pedal is stronger than the brake E
pressure applied by the system. F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
W
X
Y
Z
187
Porsche Vehicle Tracking System (PVTS)
188
Porsche Vehicle Tracking System (PVTS)
If the Driver Card is far enough away from the Operating Centre (SOC) and get the Security Activating and deactivating service mode A
vehicle, PVTS Plus will be activated after approx. Operating Centre (SOC) personnel to deactivate e Contact the Security Operating Centre (SOC) B
70 seconds. the system, or activate "Disarm mode" using the before having the vehicle serviced and after the
Theft of the vehicle can be detected. app or at www.porsche.com/connect. vehicle has been serviced. C
e When your vehicle is being serviced, please in- D
Deactivating PVTS Plus with Driver Card Transport form the relevant employee at the qualified spe-
e Store the Driver Card in the centre console of the If the vehicle is transported with the ignition cialist workshop or the Porsche partner that your E
vehicle or keep it on your person. switched off (e.g. on a ferry), transport mode must vehicle is equipped with PVTS.
F
PVTS Plus is deactivated when a Driver Card is be activated. In addition:
located in the vehicle. If the vehicle is not transported in transport mode, e PVTS Plus with Driver Card: Hand the Driver Card G
the system may trigger a false alarm, which is also with the driver's key to Customer Service to en-
H
Information subject to charge (further information is available at sure that PVTS Plus is deactivated.
www.porsche.com/connect). I
– Do not put the Driver Card in the luggage com- Information
partment or engine compartment or near metal, J
Activating and deactivating transport mode
e.g. coins. In the case of vehicle equipment PVTS Plus, the
e Contact the Security Operating Centre (SOC) K
– Do not put the Driver Card near a mobile phone. Driver Card and driver's key must be handed to Cus-
before transporting the vehicle and when you L
– Vehicles are very often stolen using stolen driv- tomer Service to ensure that PVTS Plus is deacti-
have finished transporting the vehicle.
er's keys. Do not attach the Driver Card to the vated for a service. M
– or –
driver's key.
e Via the Porsche Connect smartphone app, Car N
Connect (depending on country) or at www.por-
sche.com/connect before transporting the ve-
Changing Driver Card battery O
Information If the battery in the Driver Card is too weak, a text
hicle and when you have finished transporting P
The PVTS Plus can detect up to 7 Driver Cards per the vehicle. message will be sent automatically to the specified
vehicle. Only one Driver Card must be present in the mobile phone number. A message appears on the Q
instrument cluster.
vehicle. If you wish to add, delete or replace a Driver Service R
Card:
PVTS must be set to vehicle servicing mode in the
e Contact your Porsche partner. S
following situations:
– During customer service (e.g., for regular T
Driver Card malfunction servicing)
U
In exceptional cases (e.g. interference from radio – When the vehicle battery is disconnected
waves), the Driver Card may not be detected. A If the vehicle is not serviced in vehicle servicing
V
warning message appears on the instrument cluster. mode, the system can trigger a false alarm, for which W
you may be billed (further information is available at
Driver Card emergency deactivation www.porsche.com/connect). X
e If PVTS Plus cannot be deactivated using the Y
Driver Card (e.g. if the Driver Card battery is flat
or the Driver Card was lost), contact the Security Z
189
Porsche Vehicle Tracking System (PVTS)
190
Refuelling
191
Refuelling
A The depositing behaviour of the fuel may not meet > Please refer to chapter "Technical Data" on
requirements in some countries. In this case, the fuel page 280.
B may be mixed with the additive sold and recom- 6. Replace the tank cap immediately after refuelling
C mended by Porsche after consulting a Porsche and close it until you hear and feel it locking.
partner: 7. Close the filler flap and press on the rear of the
D Porsche part number 000 043 209 02. filler flap until it engages securely.
E e Read and follow the instructions and mixture ra-
tios specified on the container.
F Information
e Always comply with service intervals and oil
G change intervals in particular. If you lose the tank cap, you must replace it only with
an original part.
H
Filling with fuel
I
NOTICE Filler flap emergency release
J
K Decorative films may fade as a result of contact with
L fuel. Fig. 158: Opening the fuel cap
e Wipe off fuel on films immediately.
M b Engine switched off.
b Ignition switched off.
N
b Vehicle unlocked.
O 1. Open the filler flap by pressing on the rear part of
P the filler flap. The fuel type to be used for the
vehicle is printed on a sticker on the inside of the
Q filler flap.
2. Slowly unscrew and remove the fuel cap.
R
3. Put the fuel cap into the holder.
S 4. Insert the pump nozzle fully into the filler neck
T with the handle pointing downwards.
5. Operate the pump nozzle and refuel the vehicle.
U Do not add more fuel after the automatic pump
nozzle has switched off. Fuel could spray back or Fig. 159: Emergency operation of the filler flap
V
could flow over when heated. If the electrical release mechanism is faulty, the filler
W flap can be opened manually:
X 1. Open the passenger's door.
2. Reach into the door aperture between the pas-
Y Fig. 157: Opening the filler flap senger door and wing. Pull the knob up to the
Z point of resistance.
192
Refuelling
193
Roll-over protection (Cabriolet)
194
Roof Transport System
Roof Transport System driving and cause serious accidents. e Only use roof transport systems that have been A
e Secure the load so that it will not move during tested and approved by Porsche. Conventional
B
Transporting objects on the roof the journey. roof rack systems cannot be mounted on the
e Load the roof transport system so that the load vehicle. C
Unsecured or incorrectly For more information on the roof transport system:
WARNING does not protrude over the sides of the roof D
secured roof transport
transport system. Never load the roof transport e Contact your Porsche partner.
system or individual E
system wider than the width of the vehicle.
load-carrying devices
e Do not use elastic rubber tensioners. Fitting the roof transport system F
An unsecured or incorrectly secured roof transport e Position the centre of gravity of the load as low
system can become detached from the vehicle while as possible with respect to the roof transport G
driving and cause serious accidents. system and distribute the load evenly over the H
load area.
e Install individual load-carrying devices such as a I
ski/snowboard holder or roof box as centrally as
possible with respect to the supports. NOTICE J
e Check the roof transport system and load-carry- K
ing devices before every journey and at regular Washing the vehicle in a car wash or failure to ob-
intervals during longer journeys to ensure that serve the overall vehicle height or the maximum L
they are fitted correctly and securely. permitted gross weight can damage the vehicle or M
e Tighten all fastening screws again. roof transport system.
N
e Remove the complete roof transport system be-
Changed vehicle fore washing the vehicle in a car wash. O
WARNING
handling e Check the overall vehicle height with the roof
P
The handling of the vehicle changes when the roof transport system fitted before driving through
transport system is fitted and loaded. height-restricted entrances (e.g multi-storey car Q
parks).
e Adapt your driving style accordingly. R
e Do not exceed the maximum roof load, maximum Fig. 160: Components of the roof transport system
e Do not drive at a speed of more than vehicle weight and maximum axle loads. S
130 km/h (81 mph) when the roof transport A Front carrier bar (long)
B Rear carrier bar (short) T
system is loaded. C Cover trims
e When the roof transport system is fitted but not Information D Torque wrench U
loaded, do not drive at a speed of more than e Since fuel consumption and noise are increased E Key
180 km/h (110 mph). V
when the roof transport system is fitted, it When fitting for the first time:
should not remain on the vehicle if not in use.
e Adjust the front and rear carriers to fit the width
W
Unsecured or incorrectly
WARNING of the vehicle.
secured load Various objects can be transported safely and se- X
curely using the roof transport system and load- Y
An unsecured or incorrectly secured load can be-
carrying devices, e.g. ski/snowboard holder, roof box
come detached from the roof transport system while Z
or bicycle rack.
195
Roof Transport System
196
Roof Transport System
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
Fig. 165: Adjusting the length of the carriers Fig. 166: Tightening the screws on the underside of the Fig. 167: Tightening carrier fastening screws L
carriers
b. Place long carrier A at the front and short
NOTICE M
carrier B at the rear on the rotary holders G d. Remove the carriers and tighten the screws
and, at the same time, adapt to the vehicle on the underside of the carriers hand-tight N
width by means of the moveable carrier using the short side of the torque wrench. Risk of damage to the seals through pinching be-
O
supports. e. Fit the handle of the torque wrench. tween roof and supports.
5. Place the carriers on rotary holders G (Fig. 165). e Insert seals F in the support feet. P
Ensure that the carriers are fitted in accord-
ance with the stickers on the underside of the Q
6. Screw in all 8 fastening screws on the carriers
carriers. using the torque wrench until flush with the sur- R
face. Then tighten all 8 screws until the arrow
c. Tighten the screws on the underside of the S
markings on the torque wrench are exactly
carriers slightly.
aligned. T
U
V
W
X
Y
Z
197
Roof Transport System
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K Fig. 168: Inserting the load-carrying device Fig. 169: Cutting the cover trims to size and attaching
L 7. Fold the cover flaps H of the carriers fully down- 8. Cut the cover trims C to size and push them
M wards and insert the desired load-carrying de- sideways into the carriers or press them into the
vice (e.g. for roof box, bicycle rack) into the carriers from above to protect against moisture
N carrier. and dirt as well as to prevent wind noise.
O 9. Close the cover flaps and lock with the key.
P
Information
Q
After driving 50 km (30 mls), retighten all screws on
R the carriers and load-carrying devices.
S
T
U
V
W
X
Y
Z
198
Screenwash
199
Seat Belts
200
Seat Belts
A warning symbol is also displayed on the instru- Fastening seat belt belt buckle on the inner side of the seat until it A
ment cluster. locks with an audible click.
B
When the speed exceeds approx. 24 km/h (15 mph) 5. Make sure that the seat belt is not trapped or
a warning signal sounds and the red warning symbol twisted and that it is not rubbing against sharp C
C in the instrument cluster flashes if the driver edges.
D
side or occupied passenger side seat belts are not 6. Ensure that the horizontal section of the belt al-
fastened. ways fits snugly across the pelvis. Therefore, E
after fastening the seat belt, always pull the di-
agonal part of the belt upwards. F
Rear seats
When the vehicle drives off, a seat belt status dis- Pregnant women: should position the lap belt as G
play for the rear seats appears for about 30 seconds low as possible across the pelvis and ensure that
it is not pressing against the abdomen. H
in the instrument cluster.
7. Also pull on the diagonal section of the belt now I
The green symbol A indicates that the person
and again during the journey to ensure that the
sitting on this seat has fastened their seat belt. J
horizontal section remains tight.
The red symbol B indicates that the person sitting K
on this seat has not fastened their seat belt, or no-
one is sitting on this seat. If a seat belt on the rear
Opening seat-belt buckle and re- L
seats is opened while driving, an acoustic warning moving seat belt
M
signal sounds and the relevant symbol turns red and Fig. 172: Fastening seat belt
flashes for about 30 seconds . N
1. Assume a comfortable sitting position.
2. Adjust the backrest so that the seat belt always O
rests on your upper body and runs across the P
middle of your shoulder.
3. Grasp the seat belt latch and pull the belt in a Q
slow, continuous motion across your chest and
R
lap.
S
Information T
The seat belt may be blocked if the vehicle is stand- U
ing at an angle or if the seat belt is pulled out
abruptly.
V
The seat belt can also jam when accelerating or de- W
celerating, when negotiating bends or on inclines.
X
4. Insert the belt latch into the appropriate seat- Fig. 173: Removing the seat belt Y
Z
201
Seat Belts
202
Seats
Seats being squeezed or crushed when you adjust the seat. Adjusting sports seat/sports seat plus A
e Adjust the seat so that no-one is put at risk. B
Choosing the right seat position
A correct sitting position is important for safe and C
NOTICE
fatigue-free driving. To adjust the driver seat posi- D
tion to suit individual requirements, proceed as Risk of damage to headrests, roof and sun visor.
follows: E
e Set the seat position to ensure sufficient clear-
1. Adjust the seat height to ensure that you have F
ance between the headrest, roof and sun visor.
enough headroom and a good overview of the
vehicle. G
2. Adjust the seat's fore-and-aft position so that Information H
your legs are not fully straight and your foot is
touching the entire pedal surface when pressing The adjustment range of the passenger seat back- I
the pedals fully. rest is restricted in vehicles with ISOFIX anchorage
systems when using a child restraint system in the J
3. Grip the top half of the steering wheel. Set the
passenger seat. K
backrest angle and the steering wheel position
so that your arms are almost outstretched. L
However, your shoulders must still rest on the
backrest. M
Fig. 174: Adjusting semi-electric sports seat/sports seat
4. Adjust the seat's fore-and-aft position if plus N
necessary.
1 Seat height adjustment O
2 Backrest angle adjustment
Adjusting the seat 3 Fore-and-aft adjustment P
WARNING
Adjusting the seat when e Press each control in the direction indicated by Q
driving the arrows until the desired setting or the limit
R
position is reached.
The seat may move further than desired if you at-
e Pull up locking lever 3, move seat to the desired S
tempt to adjust it whilst driving. You may lose con-
fore-and-aft position and release the lever. T
trol of the vehicle.
Check that the seat engages correctly.
e Do not adjust the seat while driving. U
Seat adjustment V
CAUTION
W
If persons or animals are within the range of move- X
ment of the seat, there is a risk of parts of the body
Y
Z
203
Seats
A Adjusting fully electric sports seat/adaptive > Please refer to chapter "Personal Settings" on Using the Comfort Entry function
sports seat Plus page 169. The Comfort Entry function makes it easier for you
B
to get in and out of the vehicle.
C Folding down seat backrest Automatic adjustment of
CAUTION
D driver’s seat
E Persons behind the driver’s seat may be trapped by
the seat as a result of automatic adjustment of the
F
driver's seat towards the rear.
G e Switch off the Easy Entry function if there is a
H person behind the driver’s seat.
I
Activating function
J
The Comfort Entry function can be activated via the
K PCM.
L e CAR e CONTROL e Vehicle e Locking
M > Please refer to chapter "Vehicle Settings" on
N page 246.
Fig. 175: Adjusting fully electric sports seat/adaptive sports
seat Plus
O Exiting the vehicle
P
1 Seat angle adjustment Fig. 176: Folding down seat backrest b Function activated.
2 Seat height adjustment
3 Thigh support adjustment e Switch off the ignition and open the driver’s door.
Q Folding down seat backrest
4 Seat cushion side bolster adjustment (adaptive sports The steering wheel moves upwards.
seat Plus only) e Pull the loop at the side of the backrest upwards The driver's seat moves backwards.
R and fold the backrest forwards.
5 Seat cushion side bolster adjustment (adaptive sports
S seat Plus only)
Entering the vehicle
6 Fore-and-aft adjustment Adjusting seat backrest to vertical position
T 7 Backrest angle adjustment b Function activated.
8 Lumbar support adjustment WARNING
Seat backrest not b Driver's seat and steering wheel are in their
U engaged Comfort Entry positions.
e Press each control in the direction indicated by
V e Shut the driver's door and switch on the ignition.
the arrows until the desired setting or the end Risk of injury if seat backrests are not engaged.
The driver's seat and steering wheel move to the
W position is reached. e Check that the seat backrest engages when stored position.
X folding it back.
Storing seat settings
Y For information on storing and retrieving the seat e Fold up the backrest until it locks with an audible
settings: click.
Z
Ensure that the seat belt is not trapped.
204
Seats
When the key is changed, the seat and steering Seat heating is not available when the interior tem-
forward B
wheel move to the entry position stored on the driv- perature is high. C
er's key. Seat ventilation is not available when the interior
temperature is below 15 °C. D
205
Slide/Tilt Roof
206
Slide/Tilt Roof
Opening the glass slide/tilt roof The slide/tilt roof is lifted or lowered to the end > Please refer to chapter "Vehicle Settings" on A
position. page 246.
B
e To interrupt the process, press button B again. e When locking the vehicle, press the proximity
sensor in the door handle until the slide/tilt roof C
Closing slide/tilt roof has reached the desired position or the slide/tilt
roof has closed.
D
First setting – manual operation
e Pull and hold button A or C (only steel slide/tilt E
Closing the slide/tilt roof after repeated in-
roof) in the first setting until the desired position F
tervention of the force limiter
is reached.
The process stops when the switch is released. Anti-pinch protection G
WARNING
deactivated
Second setting – one-touch operation H
e Briefly pull button A or C (only steel slide/tilt The slide/tilt roof and sun blind close with their full I
roof) to the second setting. closing force. Parts of the body that become trapped
The slide/tilt roof closes automatically to the end between the moving and stationary vehicle parts J
position. may be crushed. K
e To interrupt the process, press button A again. e Make sure that no parts of the body become
trapped between moving and fixed vehicle parts L
Lifting and closing the slide/tilt roof with the during closing. M
Fig. 180: Operating the glass slide/tilt roof driver’s key
If the closing operation is impeded by an obstruction, N
A Opening/closing slide/tilt roof b Function activated.
the slide/tilt roof can be closed manually with in-
B Lifting/lowering slide/tilt roof > Please refer to chapter "Vehicle Settings" on creased force.
O
C Opening/closing sun blind
page 246.
1. Remove the obstruction. P
First setting – manual operation Lifting/lowering the slide/tilt roof 2. Pull button A or C (only steel slide/tilt roof) until
e Press and hold button A in the first setting until
Q
e Press and hold the button on the driver's key the slide/tilt roof stops in the closed position.
the desired position is reached. R
until the slide/tilt roof has reached the desired
The process stops when the switch is released. position. Opening and closing the sun blind S
Second setting – one-touch operation Closing slide/tilt roof Stage one – manual operation T
e Briefly press button A to the second setting. e Pull or press and hold button C in the first setting
e Press and hold the button on the driver’s key
The slide/tilt roof opens automatically to the end until the desired position is reached. U
until the slide/tilt roof has reached the desired
position. The process stops when the switch is released.
position or the slide/tilt roof has closed. V
e To interrupt the process, press button A again.
Second setting – one-touch operation W
Closing the slide/tilt roof with the proximity e Briefly pull or press button C to the second
Lifting or lowering the slide/tilt roof sensor in the door handle X
e Press button B. setting.
b Comfort Access The sun blind opens or closes automatically to Y
b Function activated. the end position.
e To interrupt the process, press button C again. Z
207
Slide/Tilt Roof
A If the slide/tilt roof is partly or fully open, the sun Overloading the tyres
WARNING
blind can only be closed as far as the front edge of
B the slide/tilt roof.
After emergency operation of the slide/tilt roof, the
C If the sun blind is closed, it will be opened (pulled aerodynamics of the vehicle may change due to in-
along) automatically when the slide/tilt roof is
D teraction with the retractable rear spoiler. This can
opened.
result in overloading of the tyres. Overloaded tyres
E Raising or lowering the slide/tilt roof does not affect
can burst, resulting in loss of control of the vehicle.
the position of the sun blind.
F e Following emergency operation, do not exceed a
G Closing the sun blind after repeated inter- speed of 130 km/h (81 mph).
vention of the force limiter e Have the slide/tilt roof repaired. Visit a qualified
H specialist workshop. Porsche recommends a
Anti-pinch protection
WARNING Porsche partner as they have trained workshop
I deactivated
personnel and the necessary parts and tools.
J The slide/tilt roof and sun blind close with their full
K closing force. Parts of the body that become trapped
between the moving and stationary vehicle parts Fig. 182: Closing the slide/tilt roof with the hexagon key
L may be crushed. 3. Insert the hexagon key all the way into the
M e Make sure that no parts of the body become opening.
trapped between moving and fixed vehicle parts 4. Applying continuous upward pressure, turn the
N during closing. hexagon key clockwise until the slide/tilt roof is
O fully closed (arrow).
If the closing process is impeded by an obstruction, 5. Remove the hexagon key.
P the sun blind can be closed manually with increased 6. Refit the cap.
force.
Q 7. Stow the key in the tool kit.
1. Remove the obstruction. The slide/tilt roof can no longer be operated. End
R 2. Pull button C until the sun blind stops in the positions cannot be saved.
S closed position.
208
Slide/Tilt Roof
Storing the end position 1. Fully open the slide/tilt roof. A
WARNING
2. Close the sun blind as far as possible.
B
The slide/tilt roof and sun blind close with their full 3. Press button A of the sun blind.
closing force when storing the end position. The sun blind starts to close after 10 seconds. C
e Make sure that nobody is injured when storing 4. Keep the switch pressed until the sun blind is D
the end position. fully closed.
5. Remove any dirt. E
b The vehicle is stationary. F
Exiting the cleaning function
1. Switch on the ignition.
e Drive off. G
2. Pull and hold button C until the slide/tilt roof – or –
stops in the closed position. H
Operate the slide/tilt roof.
3. Release button C and pull and hold again. – or – I
The process for storing the end position begins Operate the sun blind.
after approx. 10 seconds. The slide/tilt roof now J
opens and closes once automatically.
K
The end position is now stored.
e Repeat Steps 1-3 for the sun blind using button L
A.
M
If the button is released before the slide/tilt roof has
stopped moving completely: N
e Start the storing process again. O
209
Smoker's Package
H
Inserting ashtray
I
J
K
L
M
Fig. 184: Opening and closing the ashtray
N
e Open and close the ashtray by lifting and folding
O down the lid.
P Removing the ashtray
Q e Grip the ashtray and remove it.
R
S
T
U Fig. 183: Inserting ashtray
210
Socket
Socket A
B
Using the 12-volt socket
Electrical accessories can be connected to the 12- C
volt plug socket. D
The 12-volt plug socket is located in the footwell on
the passenger's side. E
F
Connecting the charging adapter G
Information H
I
– The 12-volt plug socket and the connected
electrical accessories function even if the igni- J
tion is switched off or the driver's key is removed.
If the engine is not running and the accessories
K
are switched on, the vehicle battery will be dis- Fig. 185: Charging adapter for 12-volt plug sockets L
charged. The power supply is interrupted after
about 30 minutes to protect the vehicle battery.
A Suitable charging adapters M
B Unsuitable charging adapters
If the load is to be switched on again, the ignition N
must be switched on once.
NOTICE O
– The maximum load capacity of a 12-volt plug
socket is 20 A but only if one load is operating. P
Do not exceed a 10 A load per 12-volt plug Risk of damage to the electrical system.
socket if several loads are operating e Only use suitable charging adapters (A): Q
simultaneously. The distance X between the ground connection R
– Unshielded devices and equipment can cause and the upper edge of the charging adapter must
interference to radio reception and malfunctions be less than approx. 16 mm. S
in the vehicle electronics. e Unsuitable charging adapters (B) where the dis- T
tance X between the earth connection and the
upper edge is more than 16 mm can damage the U
12-volt plug sockets. V
W
X
Y
Z
211
Spoiler
A Spoiler objects can collect in it. Current speed > 15 km/h (9 mph): Briefly press
B e Do not park the vehicle with the rear spoiler the Spoiler button.
Retractable rear spoiler extended. The rear spoiler is in automatic mode.
C
Failure of the extendible The rear spoiler improves driving stability at high
D WARNING
rear spoiler speeds. The use of automatic mode is
E recommended.
Driving stability will be adversely affected by in-
If the spoiler control fails, a warning message ap-
F creased rear axle lift at higher speeds. pears on the instrument cluster.
G e Adapt your driving style and speed to the > Please refer to chapter "Warning and Information
changed driving behaviour. Messages" on page 255.
H e Have the fault corrected at a qualified specialist
I workshop. Automatic mode
Porsche recommends a Porsche partner as they Depending on the vehicle speed and the selected
J have trained workshop personnel and the neces- driving programme, the rear spoiler is automatically
K sary parts and tools. extended or retracted.
L Extending and retracting Manual mode
CAUTION
M the rear spoiler When the ignition is switched on, the rear spoiler can
be extended and retracted manually via the PCM.
N When extending or retracting the rear spoiler man-
ually when the vehicle is stationary, parts of the
O Information
body may become trapped between the moving
P spoiler and stationary vehicle parts. The selected spoiler position can be stored in
Q e Make sure that no persons or objects are within INDIVIDUAL mode.
the range of movement of the rear spoiler.
R Manual extension
S NOTICE
e Select CAR e DRIVE e Spoiler.
T The rear spoiler is extended. The current spoiler
Risk of damage to rear spoiler.
U position is indicated in the vehicle model.
e Do not pull or push the vehicle by the rear spoiler.
V e Please retract the rear spoiler before using auto- Manual retraction
matic car washes.
W 1. Select CAR e DRIVE e Spoiler.
X NOTICE 2. Current speed < 15 km/h (9 mph): Press and
Y hold the Spoiler button until the rear spoiler has
When the rear spoiler is extended, the air supply to reached its end position.
Z the charge-air cooler can be blocked as foreign – or –
212
Sport Chrono Stopwatch
213
Sport Chrono Stopwatch
A b Timing has started. Displaying and editing recordings and re- e CAR e CHRONO e Options e Sport
cording statistics Chrono settings e Difference in distance
B e CAR e CHRONO e New lap A maximum of 99 laps can be recorded during each allowed
C The lap counter is incremented by one. The session. Provided a reference lap has not been
time of the fastest lap driven is recorded as the loaded already, the first lap of the recording is used Setting maximum time deviation for evaluation
D fastest lap time if the duration is within the set Indicates the maximum time difference with which
as the reference lap. A maximum of 10 hours of re-
E difference in distance. cording time is available. laps are evaluated as identical in speed (marked yel-
low) during the recording.
F e CAR e CHRONO e Options e Sport
Storing interim time
Chrono display e Evaluation e CAR e CHRONO e Options e Sport
G b Timing has started. Chrono settings e Max. delta time for
H evaluation
e CAR e CHRONO e Interim time Renaming, deleting, importing and exporting
I The intermediate time is displayed briefly and is recordings and reference laps Displaying the vehicle position for the fastest lap
not stored. Timing continues in the background.
J b Under Options e Sport Chrono (ghost car)
evaluation selected.
K e CAR e CHRONO e Options e Sport
Resetting the stopwatch time b For importing/exporting, SD card inserted or
Chrono settings e Show position during
L b Timing was stopped. USB data carrier connected. Data is stored on
fastest lap
M the storage medium in the "SportChrono” folder.
e CAR e CHRONO e Reset
N All stop time displays are reset to zero and the e CAR e CHRONO e Options Stopwatch in the instrument
running recording is stopped.
O cluster
Setting Sport Chrono The stopwatch is displayed on the Car & Info display.
P Loading reference lap Activating Record additional data option and dis-
Q playing track progress
e CAR e CHRONO e Load lap
R Apart from lap length and lap times, other driving
data (such as speed) can be stored at intervals of 1
S Saving reference lap second. The track progress can also be shown on the
T map.
e CAR e CHRONO e Options e Sport
U Chrono display e Evaluation e Select desired e CAR e CHRONO e Options e Sport
recording e Save reference lap Chrono settings e Record additional data
V
W Resetting reference lap Setting difference in distance allowed
Indicates how much the length of a lap may differ
X
e CAR e CHRONO e Reset from the length of the reference lap. Laps with
Y greater length deviations are not included in the
evaluation.
Z
214
Sport Chrono Stopwatch
215
Starting and Stopping the Engine
A Starting and Stopping the Information throttle until the engine has reached operating
B Engine If no loads are switched on for 10 minutes after
temperature.
C
Ignition lock
switching on the ignition, the ignition must be Stopping the engine
switched on again. Turn the control unit to ignition
D The driver's key is replaced by a control unit in the lock position 0 (initial position) first. Inactive power steering
WARNING
ignition. You only need to carry the driver's key with and brake booster
E
you.
F 2 – Start the engine The power steering and brake booster are only op-
erational while the engine is running. When the en-
G After the engine is started, the control unit auto-
gine is switched off, much greater force is suddenly
matically returns from position 2 to position 1.
H required to turn the steering wheel or brake.
e Only switch the ignition off when the vehicle is
I Locking and unlocking steering stationary.
J wheel
> Please refer to chapter "Alarm System" on 1. Stop the vehicle.
K page 38. 2. Press the brake pedal.
L 3. Turn the control unit to ignition lock position 0.
Starting the engine e When leaving the vehicle, apply the electric
M parking brake and press button P on vehicles
1. Press the brake pedal.
N with PDK or engage 1st gear or reverse gear on
2. Vehicles with manual transmission: Press the
vehicles with manual transmission.
O clutch pedal down fully and keep it pressed.
3. Vehicles with manual transmission: Move gear-
P shift lever to neutral position.
Q 4. Vehicles with PDK: Press the P button on the
Fig. 189: Ignition lock positions selector lever or select operating mode N.
R 5. Do not press the accelerator pedal.
0 Basic setting
S 1 Ignition on 6. Turn the control unit to ignition lock position 2.
2 Starting the engine Do not operate the starter for longer than approx.
T 10 seconds.
U 0 – Ignition off (initial position) After reaching ignition lock position 2, starting
(engine start) is automatically initiated and
V The engine and ignition are off in ignition lock posi-
completed.
tion 0.
W e Repeat the starting procedure after a short
1 – Ignition on pause of approx. 10 seconds if necessary. Turn
X the control unit back to ignition lock position 0
All electrical equipment can be switched on. The
Y (initial position) beforehand.
warning lights on the instrument cluster light up for
Do not run the engine warm when stationary.
Z a lamp check.
Drive off immediately. Avoid high revs and full
216
Steering Wheel
Steering Wheel position to the tilt of the backrest and seat Storing steering wheel settings A
position. On vehicles with memory package, the steering B
Adjusting steering wheel 3. Swivel the lever back to the initial position, to- wheel settings can be stored on the memory buttons
wards the driver until you feel it engage. in the driver's door and on the driver's key. C
Adjusting the steering
WARNING > Please refer to chapter "Personal Settings" on D
wheel while driving Adjusting the steering wheel electrically page 169.
The steering wheel may move further than desired if Uncontrolled retrieval of E
CAUTION
you attempt to adjust it while driving. You may lose the memory settings Operating instrument cluster with F
control of the vehicle.
If persons or animals are within the range of move-
multi-function steering wheel G
e Do not adjust the steering wheel while driving. For further information on operating the instrument
ment of the steering wheel while it is being adjusted,
cluster: H
there is a risk of body parts being trapped or
crushed. > Please refer to chapter "Operating the instru- I
Adjusting steering wheel manually
ment cluster" on page 122.
e Do not leave children in the vehicle unattended. J
Switching steering wheel heating K
on/off L
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
Fig. 190: Steering wheel adjustment lever
Fig. 191: Steering wheel adjustment control switch V
1. Swivel the lever downwards, away from the
driver. e Move the control switch under the steering col- W
2. Move the steering wheel vertically and horizon- umn in the relevant direction until the desired
Fig. 192: Heated steering wheel button X
tally in order to adjust the steering wheel setting is reached.
b Engine is running. Y
e Press the button on the central steering wheel
spoke until the message Heated steering wheel Z
217
Steering Wheel
218
Storage
219
Storage
220
Sun Visors
Sun Visors A
B
Adjusting sun visor
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
Fig. 197: Opening vanity mirror L
e Open the cover of the vanity mirror on the inside M
of the sun visor.
N
The vanity mirror light comes on.
Fig. 196: Adjusting sun visor O
NOTICE
e Swivel the sun visor down to prevent glare from P
the front.
If you are dazzled from the side:
Risk of damage to the vanity mirror cover. Q
e Unclip the sun visor from the inner bracket and e Do not force the cover beyond its end position.
R
swivel it round so that it is in front of the side
window. S
T
Opening vanity mirror U
Cover of vanity mirror
CAUTION V
open
W
The mirror glass may break in the event of an acci-
dent and may fall into the passenger compartment if X
the cover is open. Y
e Keep the cover closed when driving.
Z
221
Telephone
A Telephone
B
Brief Overview – Phone
C
This brief overview does not replace the compre-
D
hensive descriptions. Safety messages and warn-
E ings, in particular, are not replaced by this brief
overview.
F
For information on operating Porsche
G Communication Management (PCM):
H > Please refer to chapter "Porsche Communication
Management (PCM)" on page 175.
I
J
K
Fig. 198: Dialling a number (keypad)
L
M What do I want to do? What do I have to do? Where?
N Connect phone via Bluetooth® (mobile phone e PHONE e Search for new phone or select an > p. 223
O preparation) already known phone.
222
Telephone
Using mobile phones while driving may distract from Mobile phones must be switched off in certain dan- Bluetooth® W
the traffic situation. You may lose control of the ger areas, e.g. near petrol stations, fuel depots, X
chemical plants or during blasting work. They may Connecting a new mobile phone
b Bluetooth® function of the mobile phone is acti- Y
vated and is visible to other devices. Z
223
Telephone
A b Bluetooth® function of the PCM activated. 1. Search for available devices in the mobile calls, but only the active mobile phone can
> Please refer to chapter "Device Manager" on phone's Bluetooth® menu. Press or in make calls.
B
page 96. the header (depending on the connection status) 3. Select the currently connected device at the
C to make the PCM visible. top right in the headline in order to switch be-
1. PHONE e KEYPAD e Search for new 2. Select the PCM from the list of available devices.
D tween the two connected mobile phones.
phone The Bluetooth® device name of the PCM can be The two devices already connected are
E 2. Select a mobile phone from the device list. displayed by selecting Device manager under displayed.
F A 6-digit Bluetooth® code is generated and dis- Options e Bluetooth e Bluetooth name. – or –
played in the PCM and on the mobile phone. PHONE e Options e Select phone e
G Connecting to registered mobile phones
3. Compare the Bluetooth® code in the PCM and Select the desired device.
H on the mobile phone. b The mobile phone's Bluetooth® function is
activated.
I 4. If the Bluetooth® code in the mobile phone b Bluetooth® function of the PCM activated. Using the PCM for making phone
J match, confirm.
> Please refer to chapter "Device Manager" on calls with an external SIM card
When the phone is successfully connected, the page 96. In some countries, the external SIM card can also be
K numeric input (KEYPAD menu) is displayed used to make and receive calls in addition to estab-
L in the PCM. 1. Select or in the footer (depending on lishing a data connection. The embedded SIM card
the connection status). cannot be used for making and receiving calls. For
M
A list with a maximum of 20 registered mobile information on data connection:
Information
N phones will be displayed. > Please refer to chapter "Porsche Connect" on
– Depending on the Bluetooth® capability of the page 182.
O mobile phone, it is possible to access the content
2. Select a mobile phone from the list.
An inserted external SIM card deactivates the func-
The mobile phone is connected via Bluetooth®.
P of the phone book, call lists and messages. It is tion of the embedded SIM card (availability depend-
also possible to transfer a current call to the ent on country). Additional costs may be incurred for
Q mobile phone after stopping the vehicle and Connecting and using a second mobile phone the data connection (e.g. due to data roaming).
R continue it outside the vehicle if the mobile b A mobile phone is already connected to the PCM
phone supports this function. or the inserted external SIM card is enabled to Inserting and removing external SIM card
S – You will find an overview of compatible mobile make calls.
T phones on the Porsche website for your country NOTICE
under: Models e Your model (e.g. 911 Carrera) e 1. Select or in the footer (depending on
U Download Brochures e Via Bluetooth®. the connection status). If you are using a SIM card adapter, the SIM card
V 2. Select a mobile phone from the list or connect a may fall out of the adapter due to vibrations and
new mobile phone. components of the card may get stuck in the drive.
W Connecting a mobile phone (Windows® and
> Please refer to chapter "Connecting a new e Do not use adapters for SIM cards.
X iOS operating system) mobile phone" on page 223.
For mobile phones with Windows® and iOS operating Both connected mobile phones can receive
Y systems, we recommend initiating the connection
Z from the mobile phone:
224
Telephone
Data connection via the EDGE mobile e Select to mute the microphone. A
phone network (GSM).
Reception field strength of the mobile B
phone network for the phone function. Holding a call
b Active phone call.
C
Data connection via external WiFi
hotspot. D
e Select .
E
Storing and editing a favourite e To resume the call, select .
F
Fig. 199: External SIM card in the armrest
Storing a favourite Starting a conference call G
1. Insert external SIM card B (mini-SIM, dimen-
sions: 25 x 15 mm). The missing corner must 1. PHONE e FAV b Active phone call. H
be at the front left with the chip facing
2. Select a contact from Last contacted and move 1. e Add a new call (enter number or contact) I
downwards.
to Favourites by drag & drop. e J
2. SIM card with PIN:
a. If necessary, enter the PIN for the external 2. Select to activate the conference. K
Organising favourites
SIM card and confirm with OK.
3. Select to disconnect the conference. L
b. Select Store PIN. 1. PHONE e FAV
M
3. Activate Use SIM card for calls (otherwise data 2. Select the desired contact and move to the de- Switching between two conversations
services only) if necessary in order to use the sired position via drag & drop. (swapping) N
SIM card for calls in addition to data use.
b First phone call is active. O
4. To remove the external SIM card, press on the Deleting a favourite b Second phone call is on hold. P
inserted card and remove it.
1. PHONE e FAV e Select to activate the call on hold and put Q
the previously active call on hold.
Displaying connection status 2. Select the desired contact and move upwards R
The following displays may appear in the header de- from the Favourites display area via drag &
S
pending on the model, country and equipment: drop. Displaying phone information in
No phone connected.
– or –
the instrument cluster T
If available, select the icon.
No data connection available (possible e Select the desired function in the Car & Info dis- U
causes: no connection, poor network play on the instrument cluster:
V
quality, interruption of the data connec- Functions during a phone call > Please refer to chapter "D – Car & Info dis-
play" on page 120. W
b PHONE e KEYPAD
tion during a voice connection).
selected. – Incoming call: Accept or Reject the incoming call
Data connection via the LTE mobile X
phone network. using the phone buttons on the steering wheel.
Muting the microphone Y
Data connection via the UMTS/HSPA b Active phone call.
mobile phone network (3G). Z
225
Telephone
A – Last calls: Display a list of the last numbers di- Writing text messages/e-mails ports can be used to charge mobile phones and
alled using the phone button and rotary knob on connect to the PCM.
B e MESSAGE e Text message/E-
the steering wheel. 1. PHONE b Keypad/code lock on the mobile phone is
C – Conference: Make other calls or add the partici- mail activated.
pants to a conference call during an active phone e Place the mobile phone in the storage compart-
D call using the rotary knob and phone button on
2. Select .
ment with the display facing upwards.
E the steering wheel. 3. Add the recipient (by entering the number or > Please refer to chapter "Ports" on page 180.
selecting a contact).
F For information on operating the instrument cluster:
> Please refer to chapter "Operating the instru- 4. Enter text using the input field and confirm with Changing phone settings
G ment cluster" on page 122. OK.
H General settings
5. Select Send.
I
Displaying and editing messages e PHONE e Options e Telephone settings
You can read text messages and e-mails, have the Replying to or forwarding text message/e- e Select the desired setting.
J messages read out to you or use the numbers con-
mail
K tained in the messages for making phone calls if the
mobile phone supports this function. The mobile 1. PHONE e MESSAGE e Text message/E- Deleting a call
L phone may support the text message function but mail b SIM card inserted.
not the e-mail function. You will find further infor- – or –
M 2. Select the text message/e-mail that you want
mation on these settings in the operating instruc- Mobile phone is connected via Bluetooth® and
N tions for the mobile phone. to reply to/forward. supports the function.
O 3. Select e Reply/Replies/Forward. e PHONE e CALLS e Options e Delete
Information
P call
Q
– If the mobile phone is only able to display the Stowing a mobile phone (avail-
text message stored in the device memory, the
text message received in the vehicle may not ability dependent on country) Managing contacts
R
appear in the mobile phone message list. Other- e PHONE e CONTACT e Options e
S wise, received text messages are stored on the Select the desired setting.
T SIM card.
– Multimedia Messaging Service (MMS) is not
U supported by the PCM. Editing messages
V e PHONE e MESSAGE e Text message/e-
W mail folder e Options e Select the desired
setting.
X
Fig. 200: Storage compartment in the armrest
Y
Depending on the equipment, the storage compart-
Z ment in the armrest has various interfaces. The USB
226
Tests on Test Stands
Performance test W
Performance tests on roller-type test stands are not X
approved by Porsche.
Y
Z
227
Towing
A Towing NOTICE to lift the vehicle and tow it on one axle (irre-
spective of whether it is the front or rear axle).
B
Information Danger of significant vehicle damage. Special note for vehicles with a faulty or fully dis-
C
e Always observe the laws governing towing and e Tie the vehicle down only at its wheels. Do not charged battery
D attach tension straps to the towing lug. e If the battery is defective or fully discharged, the
tow-starting.
engine can only be started after the battery has
E e Exercise extreme care when your vehicle is being e Vehicles with manual transmission may only be been replaced or by using jump leads.
F
towed. Before starting off, both drivers should tow-started or push-started when the engine is > Please refer to chapter "Battery" on page 52.
familiarise themselves with the special condi- cold. If the engine is warm, unburnt fuel could > Please refer to chapter "Jump-lead Starting" on
G tions that apply to tow-starting and towing. damage the catalytic converter. page 129.
e In the case of a power failure or faults in the If the battery is defective or fully discharged, the
H electrical system, an external power source may Instructions for towing a vehicle on all four wheels
engine can only be started after the battery has been
I need to be connected in order to release the e Switch on the ignition so that the brake lights
replaced or by using jump leads.
electric parking brake or steering column lock. and direction indicator lights can operate and the
J > Please refer to chapter "Battery" on page 52. steering lock will not engage.
> Please refer to chapter "Jump-lead Starting" on
K Notes on towing on one axle (vehicles with rear-
Tow-starting and push-starting page 129.
wheel drive only)
L the vehicle e Switch off ignition. Leave the driver's key in the
M Vehicle with manual transmis- ignition lock so that the steering lock does not
NOTICE sion1 Towing engage.
N
Increased steering and e Make sure that the vehicle has sufficient lighting.
O Danger of significant vehicle and transmission dam- WARNING
age through tow-starting or push-starting vehicles braking forces as a result
P of no power assistance Towing the vehicle
with PDK.
e Vehicles with manual transmission: move gear-
Q e Never tow-start or push-start vehicles. No steering assistance is available on the towed ve- shift lever to neutral position.
e Do not attempt to tow the vehicle. hicle when its engine is not running. Increased force e Do not exceed the maximum speed of
R e Call a roadside assistance or breakdown recovery is required for braking and steering. 50 km/h (30 mph). Do not exceed a maximum
S service.
e Exercise extreme care when your vehicle is being towing distance of 50 km (30 mph). For longer
e Have the vehicle transported with both axles on a towing distances, the vehicle must be trans-
T towed.
recovery vehicle, car transporter or trailer. ported on a car transporter or a trailer.
U
Important information for vehicles with all-wheel > Please refer to chapter "Transporting the vehicle
V drive/Porsche Traction Management (PTM) on car trains, ferries and car transporters" on
e The vehicle must be moved on a car transporter page 230.
W
or a trailer, or must have all four wheels on the
X ground when being towed. It is not permissible
Y
Z
1. Equipment may be available for use only at a later time or may only be available in certain markets.
228
Towing
Pulling out a vehicle stuck in snow, sand, etc. Special note for vehicles with a faulty or fully dis- Using the towing lug A
e Always pull out the vehicle with the greatest charged battery
B
care. e If the battery is defective or fully discharged, the
e Do not pull out the vehicle abruptly or at an engine can only be started after the battery has C
angle. been replaced or by using jump leads.
> Please refer to chapter "Battery" on page 52.
D
e If possible, pull the vehicle out backwards in its
own tracks. > Please refer to chapter "Jump-lead Starting" on E
page 129.
> Please refer to chapter "Transporting the vehicle
F
Towing a vehicle with PDK on car trains, ferries and car transporters" on G
page 230.
H
Using a towing rope or towing bar I
e For specifications and mounting instructions, J
please refer to the manual from the accessory
manufacturer. Observe the manufacturer's K
safety and operating instructions. L
e Observe the permissible towing force of the
towing rope or towing bar. The towing rope or Fig. 203: Towing lug M
Fig. 201: Permissible towing
towing bar must be approved for the vehicle N
weight. Never exceed the manufacturer’s Fitting the towing lug
specifications. The towing lug is stored in the tool kit.
O
e The towed vehicle must not be heavier than the > Please refer to chapter "Luggage compartment" P
towing vehicle. on page 146.
e Vehicles with defective brakes must not be 1. Press the lower edge of the plastic cover into the
Q
towed. bumper until it disengages or carefully disengage R
e When towing, screw the towing lug to the ve- the plastic cover using a suitable tool (e.g.
hicle before the towing rope or towing bar is se- screwdriver). S
cured to the towing lug. 2. Pull the plastic cover out of the bumper and let it T
> Please refer to chapter "Using the towing lug" hang by its thread.
on page 229. 3. Screw in towing lug A anti-clockwise as far as it
U
Using a towing rope will go (left-hand thread) and tighten hand-tight. V
e Always keep the towing rope taut when towing. W
Avoid jerky and sudden loads.
X
Using a towing bar
e Do not attach the towing bar diagonally between Y
Fig. 202: Impermissible towing the vehicles. Z
229
Towing
G
Transporting the vehicle on car
H trains, ferries and car transporters
I 1. Tie the vehicle down only at its wheels. Do not
attach tension straps to the towing lug.
J
2. Deactivate interior surveillance and the inclina-
K tion sensor.
> Please refer to chapter "Alarm System" on
L
page 38.
M 3. Activate Porsche Vehicle Tracking System Plus
(PTVS Plus) transport mode.
N
> Please refer to chapter "Transport" on page 189.
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
W
X
Y
Z
230
Traffic Sign Detection
Traffic Sign Detection compared with the information provided by the ve- Information A
hicle (e.g. rain sensor, navigation data and time).
WARNING
Lack of attention To ensure there is no interference with camera B
The bend ahead warning is issued approx. 150 m
before a bend that is significant for the driver and operation: C
Responsibility when driving, e.g. choosing an appro- continues until the relevant bend has been passed. – Do not cover the camera area on the interior
mirror A with objects (e.g. stickers). D
priate speed, remains with the driver even if traffic Traffic sign detection is country-dependent and is
sign detection is being used. The system is no sub- not available for all countries. – The camera must always be kept free of dirt, ice E
stitute for attention on the part of the driver. When driving in a country in which traffic sign de- and snow.
F
Traffic sign detection does not adjust the speed of tection is not available, the driver is alerted to this
the vehicle to specified speed limits. fact by a message on the instrument cluster. G
Information
e Drive with extreme care. H
e Always pay attention to the traffic situation and If the camera does not detect a traffic sign, the
the area around the vehicle. speed limit stored in the navigation system will be I
e Adapt your driving speed to traffic conditions. automatically displayed. J
Failure of camera to de- K
WARNING
tect traffic signs L
Camera vision can be impaired by various factors (e. M
g. rain, snow, ice, heavy spray and oncoming head- Fig. 204: Windscreen camera
N
lights). Sometimes the camera cannot detect traffic
signs or cannot detect them correctly. When this Information O
happens, no speed limit or bend ahead warning, or an
Traffic sign detection is available in limited form in P
incorrect speed limit or bend ahead warning is dis-
played. Traffic signs on the road always have priority. the following sample situations for example: Q
– Camera heavily soiled, iced-up or covered (e.g.
e Always pay attention to traffic signs when driv- R
stickers)
ing on public roads.
– In unfavourable weather conditions (e.g. heavy S
e Drive with extreme care.
rain)
e Always keep the direction of travel in your field of T
– Traffic signs covered or damaged
view.
U
Traffic sign detection uses a camera A to detect
V
speed limits as well as the start and end points of
no-overtaking zones and bend ahead signs. Traffic W
signs are evaluated in combination with the naviga-
tion system’s map data and shown on the instru- X
ment cluster. Y
If a speed limit is confined to a wet road, fog or a
certain time, the detected additional sign is Z
231
Traffic Sign Detection
F
G Speed limit warning
H A speed limit warning with a warning threshold of
0 – 20 km/h (0 – 12 mph) can be activated in the
I PCM. When this threshold is exceeded, the relevant
J traffic sign starts to "glow". The first time it is ex-
ceeded, the displayed traffic sign also flashes.
K
Activating speed limit warning
L
M e ASSIST e Options e Speed limits
N
Fig. 205: Traffic sign display on the instrument cluster
O A Main traffic signs
P B Additional signs
C Bend ahead warning
Q
Up to three main traffic signs A including additional
R signs B can be displayed in the Speed & Assist dis-
S play on the instrument cluster. The highest priority
traffic sign is displayed on the left.
T After the ignition is switched on, the most recent
U speed limit in force appears in the instrument clus-
ter. If no speed limit is detected (e.g. on a motorway
V that has no speed limit) or if traffic sign detection is
not available in the current area, a message appears
W
in the instrument cluster.
X > Please refer to chapter "Warning and Information
Messages" on page 255.
Y
Z
232
Transmission
Transmission Starting the engine Reading the indicator for operating mode and A
The engine can only be started if the brake pedal is engaged gear
B
Driving with Porsche Doppelkup- pressed and mode P or N is activated.
C
plung (PDK) Driving off in the vehicle
The 8-speed Porsche Doppelkupplung (PDK) is a D
e Only select the desired operating mode for driv-
transmission featuring an automatic and a manual E
ing off (D, M or R) when the engine is idling and
shifting mode.
keep the brake pedal pressed while doing so. F
In automatic shifting mode (operating mode D),
e Since the vehicle crawls when in gear, only re-
gear changing is automatic. You can change tempo- G
lease the brake if you intend to drive off.
rarily from automatic to manual shifting mode using
the shift paddles on the steering wheel. Driving off on hills H
> Please refer to chapter "HOLD function" on
In manual shifting mode (operating mode M), you I
page 119.
can change gear using the shift paddles on the
steering wheel. You can switch between the D and M J
Stopping the vehicle
modes as required while driving.
e Make sure that the gearshift paddles on the e During brief stops (e.g. at traffic lights), leave the K
steering wheel are not accidentally operated in selector lever in operating mode D or M and hold L
automatic and manual shifting mode, triggering the vehicle with the brake pedal.
unintended gearshifts. e Do not hold the vehicle on a slope using the ac- M
celerator. Use the brake pedal or the electric N
Fig. 206: Indicator for operating mode and engaged gear
Changing operating mode parking brake instead.
Operating mode P is active when the ignition is e Before leaving the vehicle, always apply the When the engine is running, the operating mode A O
electric parking brake and activate operating and engaged gear B are shown.
switched off. P
mode P. If the operating mode is inadvertently switched from
The brake pedal must be pressed when switching Q
P or N to a different operating mode without the
from P to N, D or R.
Parking the vehicle brake being applied, the operating mode does not
The brake pedal must be pressed when switching R
from D to R or from R to D. e Press the accelerator pedal gently! change. A message appears on the instrument
e When parking or manoeuvring in a small space, cluster. S
It is only possible to switch to the M operating mode
control the speed by careful use of the brake e To drive off, press the brake pedal and select the
from the D operating mode. In order to switch to the T
pedal. desired operating mode again from P or N.
P operating mode, either the P button on the selec- U
Operating mode R or D flashes in the instrument
tor lever has to be pressed or the ignition switched
cluster
off. V
An attempt has been made to select operating mode
R above the permissible limit speed. W
P button
e Press the brake pedal and re-select the desired X
The P button on the selector lever activates the
operating mode from P or N.
transmission parking lock. When the ignition is Y
switched off, the transmission parking lock is auto-
matically engaged in the D, M or R operating modes. Z
233
Transmission
234
Transmission
235
Transmission
A A message appears on the instrument cluster. clutch pedal is fully depressed and the gear has Shifting from 7th to 5th gear
B
3. Release the brake pedal within one second. engaged fully. e Recommendation: From 7th gear, first shift to
e Select an appropriately low gear on upward and the neutral position N (gearshift lock active) and
C With manual transmission1 downward slopes. then into 5th gear.
This will ensure optimum use of engine power
D driving and engine braking Displaying engaged gear
E The gear indicator in the instrument cluster indicates
F Information the currently engaged gear.
G Gears 1 to 6 are designed for normal and perform- Engaging reverse gear
H
ance-oriented driving (top speed is achieved in e Select reverse gear only when the vehicle is
6th gear). stationary.
I 7th gear is designed for reduced engine speed, so e Reverse gear can be engaged after moving the
that an increase in comfort is achieved at higher gearshift lever to the left past the stop.
J speeds while reducing fuel consumption at the same When reverse gear is selected and the ignition is
K time. switched on, the reversing lights come on.
L
Driving with upshift prompt
M Shifting the transmission to neutral
The consumption-orientated upshift indicator in the
The neutral position N of the transmission is be-
N instrument cluster helps the driver develop a fuel-
tween 3rd and 4th gear.
saving driving style.
O
Shifting to 7th gear The upshift indicator lights up - prompting you to
P A sequential gearshift lock is installed to prevent an shift up to the next-higher gear - depending on the
Fig. 210: Shift pattern on the gear lever selected gear, engine speed and accelerator pedal
Q accidental shift to 7th gear when a sporty driving
Blocked pedals style is adopted. position.
R WARNING
7th gear can only be selected from an engaged 5th e Change to the next-higher gear when the upshift
S or 6th gear (see (Fig. 210), white/yellow line). indicator lights up.
Unsuitable or incorrectly secured floor mats and
T other objects can restrict the movement of the ped- Shifting from 7th to 6th gear Observing permitted engine speed
als or interfere with operation of the pedals.
U e Guide the gear lever with slight pressure to the e Change into a higher gear or ease off the accel-
e Ensure the floor mats or other objects do not in- right from 7th into 6th gear. erator before the needle reaches the red mark on
V terfere with the movement of the pedals. the tachometer.
If the red zone is reached during acceleration, fuel
W e When changing gears, always ensure that the
feed is interrupted.
X
Y
Z
1. Equipment may not be available until a later date or may only be available in certain markets.
236
Transmission
NOTICE A
B
Risk of engine damage (overrevving) when shifting
down to a lower gear. C
e Take care not to exceed the maximum permitted D
engine speed when shifting down.
E
F
Driving with gear shift assist
G
H
I
J
K
Fig. 212: Example: higher gear L
When all the segments are filled in red, a + sign ap- M
pears next to the engaged gear in the display as a
prompt to shift to the next-higher gear. N
O
P
Q
R
Fig. 211: Example of gear shift assist S
e Gear shift assist T
In order to provide assistance during performance- U
oriented driving, the upshift indicator is displayed.
The gearshift assist displays a prompt to shift to the V
next-higher gear with a pre-indication via segments W
that fill up. The sequence in which the segments are
filled with colour is white, yellow, red. X
Y
Z
237
Tyres and Wheels
A Tyres and Wheels against loss of pressure in two stages (yellow and
In addition to correct tyre inflation pressure and red tyre pressure warning, depending on the extent
B of the pressure loss).
correct wheel alignment, the service life of the tyres
C also depends on your driving style. Abrupt accelera- The tyre pressure warning light goes out only when
tion, high cornering speeds and heavy braking in- the tyre pressure has been corrected.
D
crease tyre wear. Tyre wear is also greater at higher The yellow tyre pressure warning is displayed for
E outside temperatures and on rough road surfaces. around 10 seconds after the car comes to a stand-
still and the ignition has been switched off or when
F
Complying with load and speed the ignition is switched on again. The yellow tyre
G pressure warning can be acknowledged when the
requirements ignition is switched on. The red tyre pressure warn-
H e Drive at an appropriate speed. ing also appears during driving and can be
I e Do not overload the vehicle and check the roof acknowledged.
load. e If the tyre pressure warning light lights up and a
J > Please refer to chapter "Technical Data" on tyre pressure warning is displayed despite the
K page 280. correct tyre pressure: Visit a qualified specialist
workshop. Porsche recommends a Porsche part-
L
Checking tyre pressure Fig. 213: Tyre pressure plate ner as they have trained workshop personnel and
M The tyre inflation pressure must match the pre- the necessary parts and tools.
NOTICE scribed value. These values are for cold tyres (20 °
N C). Information
O Insufficient tyre pressure can cause tyres to over- e Observe tyre pressure plate.
Tyre Pressure Monitoring gives a warning about a
heat and thus be damaged – even invisibly. e Check the tyre pressure at least every 2 weeks
P pressure drop caused by natural diffusion as well as
e Hidden tyre damage will not be eliminated by when the tyres are cold.
about a gradual loss of pressure caused by foreign
Q correcting the tyre pressure. objects. Tyre Pressure Monitoring cannot warn you
R e Never let air out of warm tyres. When tyres are Tyre Pressure Monitoring (TPM) about tyre damage that occurs suddenly (e.g. a flat
warm, the tyre inflation pressure is increased. Tyre Pressure Monitoring offers the following tyre due to unexpected external effects).
S This could cause the tyre pressure to fall below functions:
T the prescribed value. – Permanent monitoring of tyre pressure and Defective tyres
WARNING
temperature.
U – Display of actual tyre pressure (actual pressure)
Driving with defective tyres can result in serious
V while driving.
accidents.
– Tyre pressure warnings in two stages (yellow and
W red warning). e If a red tyre pressure warning appears on the in-
X – Vehicle is stationary: Display of the pressure de- strument cluster: Stop immediately in a suitable
viation from the required pressure. place and check tyres for damage. If necessary,
Y correct the damage using tyre sealant or fit the
Z The tyre pressure warning light and a corre-
sponding message on the instrument cluster warn
238
Tyres and Wheels
spare wheel. Viewing tyre pressure e Always use the pressure deviation from the dis- A
e Do not continue driving with defective tyres. The individual tyre pressures are only displayed play or from the corresponding tyre pressure
warning to correct the tyre pressure. B
Have defective tyres replaced immediately. Visit above a speed of approx. 25 km/h (16 mph) or if the
a qualified specialist workshop. Porsche recom- tyre has been inflated by at least 0.1 bar (1.5 psi). C
mends a Porsche partner as they have trained When the ignition is switched on after the vehicle Setting tyres
D
workshop personnel and the necessary parts and has been stationary for more than approx. 10 mi- Settings for the tyre type and tyre size, load and
tools. nutes, lines (-.-) are shown instead of the tyre comfort/standard pressure can be made via the E
e Do not drive with tyres in which the tyre pressure pressures. touch display in the dashboard:
> Please refer to chapter "Tyre Pressure Monitor- F
drops again very quickly. In case of doubt, have
e Tyre pressure e Current press. ing (TPM)" on page 238.
tyres checked by a qualified specialist workshop. G
Porsche recommends a Porsche partner as they The display of the actual pressure is only for infor-
H
have trained workshop personnel and the neces- mation. The tyre pressures change depending on the Configuring Tyre Pressure Moni-
sary parts and tools. temperature.
toring (TPM) in the PCM I
e Under no circumstances should the tyre pres-
High speed with comfort Incorrect settings J
sures be changed based on this display. WARNING
WARNING
pressure K
Displaying pressure difference
Driving at excessive speeds when the comfort pres- Low or high tyre pressure irreparably damages the L
sure is active will destroy the tyres and wheels. tyre and the wheel, lengthens the braking distance
M
and greatly increases the risk of an accident.
e Reduce speed to below the maximum speed
Despite the Tyre Pressure Monitoring system, it is N
displayed on the instrument cluster.
e Inflate the tyres to the standard tyre pressure still the driver’s responsibility to ensure that the O
when driving at higher speeds. tyres are inflated with the correct tyre pressure and
the vehicle settings are correct. Incomplete or in- P
correct settings may affect the accuracy of warnings Q
Faults in the Tyre Pressure Monitoring (TPM) and messages.
system e Adapt tyre pressure to suit your specific tyres R
Fig. 214: Example of pressure difference
TPM will not function correctly in the following sit- and the payload. S
uations, for example: b The vehicle is stationary. e Make sure that the settings in the TPM menu
T
– If the Tyre Pressure Monitoring is faulty e Tyre pressure e Deviation correspond to the tyres fitted on the vehicle and
– If wheel transmitters for Tyre Pressure Monitor- its payload (especially after a wheel change or U
ing are missing The difference to the required pressure is displayed changes in vehicle loading).
V
– During the learning phase after the tyre settings on the relevant wheel. Example: e Then select the type and size of fitted tyre again
have been updated If –0.1 bar (–1.5 psi) is displayed for the rear right
in the TPM menu, even if the settings for the W
wheel, 0.1 bar (1.5 psi) must be added to this tyre.
– After a wheel change without updating the tyre newly fitted set of wheels are the same as for the
settings
The displayed pressures take into account the tyre X
old wheels.
temperature.
– If tyre temperatures are too high Y
Z
239
Tyres and Wheels
A Displaying pressure deviation and filling e CAR e CONTROL e Vehicle e Tyre Teaching in Tyre Pressure Monitoring
information pressure monitoring e Tyre selection Tyre Pressure Monitoring begins to learn the tyres
B
b The vehicle is stationary. after a wheel change, wheel transmitter replacement
C Selecting full load or partial load or update of the tyre settings. During this process,
e CAR e CONTROL e Vehicle e Tyre Tyre Pressure Monitoring recognises the wheels and
D
pressure monitoring e Tyre pressure e CAR e CONTROL e Vehicle e Tyre their locations. Position and pressure information is
E The required pressure and the pressure deviation Pressure Monitoring e Full load displayed as soon as Tyre Pressure Monitoring has
assigned the wheels recognised as belonging to the
F from the required pressure at the relevant wheel as Full load vehicle to the correct wheel positions.
well as the setting for load, tyre type and size are Full load is activated.
G displayed. During this process, the required pressures for cold
Full load tyres (20 °C) are displayed in the PCM and a mes-
H Example: If –0.1 bar (–1.5 psi) is displayed for the Partial load is activated. sage appears on the instrument cluster.
rear right wheel, 0.1 bar (1.5 psi) must be added to
I this tyre. The displayed pressures take into account e Adapt the tyre pressures to the selected load The tyre pressure warning light on the instru-
the tyre temperature. type. ment cluster remains lit until all the wheels have
J
e Always use the pressure deviation from the dis- been taught in.
K play or from the corresponding tyre pressure Information
L warning to correct the tyre pressure.
If the option Full load is not displayed, the specified
Inflating tyres
If the tyres are not yet taught, the new required
M tyre pressures are valid for all types of vehicle load. Hot filling hose
pressures are displayed instead of the actual pres- CAUTION
N sure deviations.
Selecting comfort or standard pressure The compressor’s filling hose can get hot during the
O Setting tyre type and tyre size
The tyre pressures can be reduced to increase driv- inflation process and can cause burns.
P ing comfort. e Wear gloves.
Information If comfort pressure is selected, Tyre Pressure Mon-
Q The compressor is located under the cover in the
The options available depend on the model and tyre itoring automatically uses lower nominal pressure
R luggage compartment.
values when monitoring tyre pressure.
type. For this reason, some of the selection options > Please refer to chapter "Luggage compartment"
S shown here may not be available.
e CAR e CONTROL e Vehicle e Tyre on page 146.
e Before fitting tyres and wheels with dimensions > Read and follow the operating instructions on the
T pressure monitoring e Comfort pressure
that are not available for selection in the TPM compressor.
U menu, the missing information should be added. Comfort pressure
Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Porsche 1. Screw the compressor’s filler hose onto the tyre
V Comfort pressure is activated.
recommends a Porsche partner as they have valve.
Comfort pressure 2. Connect the compressor to a plug socket in the
W trained workshop personnel and the necessary Standard pressure is activated.
parts and tools. vehicle and switch on the compressor.
X e Adapt the tyre pressures to comfort pressure or
e Use only tyres and wheels authorised by Porsche. The tyre is inflated.
standard pressure. 3. Check inflation pressure using the pressure
Y
Z
240
Tyres and Wheels
gauge and reduce tyre pressure or add more air if Reading off inscription on tyres Y up to 300 km/h (186 mph) A
necessary. Check the inflation pressure again.
B
4. Switch off compressor. (Y) up to 300 km/h (186 mph) as for Y
5. Unscrew the compressor’s filler hose. tyres. Speeds of more than 300 km/h C
(186 mph) are also possible at a max- D
Information imum tyre load capacity of 85 % (con-
firmation from tyre manufacturer E
The tyre pressure can also be checked at a service required for speeds of more than
station and the tyres can be inflated. F
300 km/h (186 mph)).
G
Reducing inflation pressure H
1. Switch off compressor. Detecting tyre damage
2. Open air bleed screw on the filler hose until the I
Hidden tyre damage and
correct inflation pressure is achieved. WARNING J
rim flange damage
K
Hidden tyre damage can cause the tyre to burst. You
may lose control of the vehicle. L
e Check tyres, including the sidewalls, regularly for M
Fig. 215: Inscription on tyres
foreign bodies, nicks, cuts, cracks and bulges.
A Nominal width in mm e Cross kerb edges slowly and at right angles if N
B Cross-section ratio in % possible. Avoid heavy or sharp-angled impact
C Belt type code letter
O
against steep and sharp kerbs or sharp-edged
D Rim diameter in inches P
E Load rating code number objects (e.g. stones).
F Speed code letter e If in doubt, have the wheel – particularly the in- Q
ner side – checked by an expert. Visit a qualified
The speed code letter F indicates the maximum specialist workshop. Porsche recommends a R
permitted speed for the tyre. Porsche partner as they have trained workshop S
personnel and the necessary parts and tools.
H up to 210 km/h (130 mph) e Tyres must never be repaired under any circum- T
stances. Sealing the tyre with the tyre sealant is U
V up to 240 km/h (150 mph) only an emergency solution to enable you to
drive to the nearest workshop. V
W up to 270 km/h (168 mph)
W
In the case of the following tyre damage, the tyre
must be replaced for safety reasons: X
– Tyre damage where the possibility of a ply frac-
Y
ture cannot be ruled out.
Z
241
Tyres and Wheels
A – If the tyre has been thermally and mechanically workshop personnel and the necessary parts and If valve caps are missing, the valve is unprotected
overloaded following a loss of pressure or other tools. from dust and dirt, resulting in leaks.
B previous damage. e Adapt your driving style to the changed vehicle e Always screw on valve caps tightly to protect
C handling. valve inserts from dirt. Dirty valve inserts can
Changing tyres and wheels e Only use tyres with tyre pressure sensors for Tyre cause creeping air loss.
D
e Switch off the ignition when changing a wheel. Pressure Monitoring (TPM). e Replace missing valve caps immediately.
E e Make sure that the wheels are compatible with e Use only plastic valve caps.
Lack of grip the TPM system in the vehicle. For information
F WARNING
on suitable wheels and on the TPM system in the Using winter tyres
G In the initial period, new tyres do not yet have their vehicle: Contact your Porsche partner.
full road-holding ability or grip. e When changing a tyre, check the battery charge WARNING
Exceeding the maximum
H permitted speed
condition of the tyre pressure sensors: Visit a
e You should therefore drive at moderate speeds
I qualified specialist workshop. Porsche recom-
during the first 200 km (125 miles) to extend Exceeding the maximum permitted speed can cause
mends a Porsche partner as they have trained
J the service life of the tyres and achieve full per-
workshop personnel and the necessary parts and tyres to burst.
K
formance capability. tools. e Observe the maximum permitted speed for the
e Only fit tyres of the same make with the same > Please refer to chapter "Technical Data" on tyre.
L page 280. e Only fit winter tyres with a maximum permitted
specification number (e.g. "N..." etc.).
M speed rating that is lower than the specified
e Before fitting new tyres, inquire about their cur-
maximum vehicle speed if they bear the M+S
N rent approval status: Contact your Porsche Information
designation or the snowflake symbol, depending
partner.
O If new tyres are fitted to only one axle, the different on the country, on the tyre sidewall. Observe
e Use only tyre makes tested and approved by
tread depths on the two axles can cause a marked country-specific laws.
P Porsche.
change from the previous driving behaviour to which e Affix a sticker showing the maximum permitted
e The deviation in tread depth on an axle must not you have become accustomed. This is particularly
Q speed in the driver’s field of vision. Observe
be more than 30 %. true when new tyres are fitted to the rear axle. The country-specific laws.
e Only use second-hand tyres if you know their
R effect is reduced continuously, however, as tyre e Set the maximum permitted speed as the speed
history. mileage increases.
S limit.
e Always replace both tyres on an axle so that dif-
T ferent profile depths will not unnecessarily influ- e Install winter tyres in a timely manner before the
U
ence vehicle handling. Checking and replacing valves and cold season begins.
e Tyres should only be fitted by professionals. Visit e Use only tyre makes tested and approved by
V a qualified specialist workshop. Porsche recom-
valve caps
Porsche.
e Use only genuine Porsche valves for the Tyre
W
mends a Porsche partner as they have trained e Before fitting new tyres, inquire about their cur-
Pressure Monitoring (TPM) system.
rent approval status: Contact your Porsche
X e Check the valves whenever the tyres are
partner.
changed and replace them if necessary. Porsche
Y recommends a Porsche partner as they have
Z trained workshop personnel and the necessary
parts and tools.
242
Tyres and Wheels
243
Tyres and Wheels
A Caring for wheel attachment faces have been manufactured according to Porsche Changing a wheel
specifications and production requirements.
B
e Tighten wheel bolts to a tightening torque of Preparing the vehicle
C 160 Nm (118 ftlb.). 1. Activate the transmission parking lock using the
e Do not use any force-activated tools such as P button.
D
impact screwdrivers. 2. Activate the electric parking brake.
E 3. Switch off ignition.
Using security wheel bolts 4. Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling
F
away, e.g. by placing wheel chocks at the wheels
G on the opposite side.
H 5. Slightly loosen the wheel bolts or wheel nuts on
the wheel to be changed.
I 6. Lift the vehicle only at the specified jacking
J points.
> Please refer to chapter "Jack and Lifting
K Platform" on page 128.
L 7. Raise the vehicle until the wheel lifts off the
ground.
M
Fig. 216: Wheel attachment faces
N
NOTICE
O
P Risk of damage to the wheel and wheel attachment
Q face.
e The wheel attachment face B on the brake disc Fig. 217: Adapter for security wheel bolts
R and on the wheel hub itself must not be greased.
S e Only the areas A may be greased. Grease these The adapter for the security wheel bolts is located in
areas very thinly with Optimoly® TA: Contact your the tool kit.
T Porsche partner. Do not use any other grease or e To loosen and tighten the wheel bolt with an-
U paste. titheft protection, the adapter must be used be-
tween the wheel bolt and the wheel bolt wrench.
V e When positioning the adapter ensure that it en-
Caring for wheel bolts gages fully in the teeth of the wheel bolt.
W
e Always clean the wheel bolts before fitting.
X e Wheel bolts must not be greased.
Y e Replace damaged wheel bolts. Only use genuine
Porsche wheel bolts assigned especially to this
Z model, or wheel bolts of similar quality which
244
Tyres and Wheels
Changing a wheel 1. For vehicles without PCCB: Remove one wheel > Please refer to chapter "Configuring Tyre A
bolt and screw in one assembly aid. Pressure Monitoring (TPM) in the PCM" on
– or – page 239. B
1. For vehicles with PCCB: Remove two wheel bolts C
and screw in two assembly aids A and B.
D
NOTICE E
245
Vehicle Settings
A Vehicle Settings
B Different vehicle settings can be adjusted depending on the model, country and equipment. The vehicle settings described here are therefore not available in all
models, countries and equipment versions. For safety reasons, some functions are only available when the vehicle is stationary.
C
The vehicle settings remain stored after the ignition is switched off.
D > Please refer to chapter "Personal Settings" on page 169.
E What do I want to do? What should I choose? Where?
F
Set locking and unlocking options e CAR e CONTROL e Vehicle e Locking
G
H Adjust lighting, windscreen wipers and exterior mirror e CAR e CONTROL e Vehicle e Light and visibility
I
Adjust seat heating, seat ventilation and seat position e CAR e CONTROL e Vehicle e Seat settings
J
K Set Tyre Pressure Monitoring (TPM) e CAR e CONTROL e Vehicle e Tyre Pressure Monitoring > p. 238
L
Set quick access buttons (◊ buttons) on the multi-function steering e CAR e CONTROL e Vehicle e Quick access buttons
M wheel/on the centre console switch panel
N
Program garage door opener (HomeLink®) e CAR e CONTROL e Vehicle e Garage door opener > p. 117
O
P Display service history (electronic service record) e CAR e CONTROL e Vehicle e Service history
Q The servicing performed and the service scope are displayed.
R Modify the PCM display e CAR e CONTROL e Show e PCM display
S
T Modify the instrument cluster display e CAR e CONTROL e Show e Instrument cluster display
U
Modify customised view in the instrument cluster e CAR e CONTROL e Displays e Display instrument cluster e
V Content e Customised view
W Four fields can be filled with a variety of vehicle information via drag &
drop. One item of vehicle information cannot be assigned to several
X
fields.
Y
Set date and time e CAR e CONTROL e System e Date and time
Z
246
Vehicle Settings
247
Voice Control
– Stress voice commands evenly, without long – New input Operating the list by voice control A
pauses in your speech. – Correction: If, for example, a telephone num-
ber was input in several blocks (e.g. 0711 Browsing through a list B
– Reduce disruptive sounds caused by closing
doors, windows and sliding roof, for example. 911), the most recent block input is deleted. C
– Pause: Pauses voice control, e.g. when dic- e In order to scroll forwards/backwards in a list in
– Only the driver should issue voice commands, as
tating a message. Voice control can be the PCM, say Next page/previous page. D
the hands-free microphone is pointed towards – or –
the driver's side. paused for a maximum of 5 minutes. When E
this time elapses, the dialogue is automati- Navigate a list via touch display or rotary push
cally terminated. button. F
Adapting voice control – Help: Input assistance with possible voice G
1. CAR e CONTROL e System e Voice
commands is displayed. Saying a list entry
– Cancel List entries and line numbers marked in blue in the
H
control
– Dialogue-related voice commands are needed touch display in the dashboard can be spoken. I
2. Select the desired setting. as soon as a dialogue is conducted with the PCM, e Say the voice command Line 1.
e.g. Line 1, Next page/Previous page, Yes/No – or –
J
Saying voice commands Say a list entry marked in blue. K
Information
There are three types of voice commands: L
– Global voice commands can always be used. If, More information about Porsche Connect (help vid-
eos, Porsche Connect operating instructions and
M
for example, the main menu NAV is active
and the command Radio station XY is spoken, questions & answers) can be found at www.porsche. N
the station mentioned is called up. com/connect and in the "Good to know" app (avail-
ability dependent on country). O
– General and valid voice commands can be spo-
ken at any point in the dialogue: P
Q
Global voice commands for radio
R
What do I want to do? What do I have to say? Information S
Switch reception range (Set/switch on) tuner e.g. FM/DAB/Online Radio T
U
Select station Select station Only stations that can currently be received can be
spoken. V
W
Tune to a station that can currently be (Switch on) station e.g. station XY Only stations that can currently be received can be
received spoken. X
Y
Enter frequency (Play) frequency e.g. 91.1 FM Directly selecting a frequency may cause the reception
range to change. Z
249
Voice Control
250
Voice Control
Use natural voice commands Examples: I want to call John Smith. As an alternative to actual commands, the PCM can L
Call John Smith on the mobile phone. detect natural voice commands (not available in all M
Show me my call list. languages).
Dial the last number again.
N
O
Global voice commands for P
navigation Q
251
Voice Control
E Search for a destination online Online Search/Internet search for e.g. a baker’s shop The service is not available in all languages and
F markets.
> Please refer to chapter "Porsche Connect" on
G page 182.
H
Select country Enter country/change country
I
J Select town/city Enter location
K Search for a restaurant/rest area/toi- Next Restaurant/Rest area/Toilet/ATM/Petrol station Shows the respective search criterion nearby.
L let/cash machine/petrol station
252
Voice Control
253
Voice Control
254
Warning and Information Messages
255
Warning and Information Messages
256
Warning and Information Messages
257
Warning and Information Messages
I TPM Fault in Tyre Pressure Monitoring (TPM) system. Tyre pressure is not
flashes or
J fault monitored.
lights up
Service necessary e Have the fault corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.*
K
L Tyre Pressure Monitoring (TPM) is temporarily inactive, e.g. in the case of
System briefly not overheated sensors or interference signals.
M flashes or available
Tyre pressure is not monitored.
N lights up Temporary status
If the fault persists:
Driving permitted
O e Have the fault corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.*
P
TPM Tyre Pressure Monitoring (TPM) requires the displayed speed to learn the
Q flashes or inactive wheels.
lights up System learning above During this time, the current tyre pressures are not displayed.
R
xx km/h e Perform Tyre Pressure Monitoring again later.
S
T Tyre change After the wheels have been changed, the tyre settings must be updated.
flashes or detected e Update tyre settings.
U lights up
> Please refer to chapter "Vehicle Settings" on page 246.
Update settings
V
Tyre pressure too Speed for set tyre pressure has been exceeded.
W
low e Reduce speed.
X or e Check the tyre pressure at the next opportunity.
lights up
Y Comfort pressure
Z Reduce speed
258
Warning and Information Messages
* Porsche recommends a Porsche partner as they have trained workshop personnel and the necessary parts and tools.
E
F
Engine G
H
Display Message Meaning and action required
I
The minimum oil level has been exceeded. J
e Stop immediately in a suitable place and switch off the engine.
e Check whether there is an obvious oil leak on or under the vehicle. Do not K
Oil level critical
continue driving if there is an obvious oil leak. L
Add up to e Call up oil measurement in instrument cluster.
M
xx l e Add oil if necessary.
> Please refer to chapter "Engine oil" on page 108. N
e Have the fault corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.* O
Oil level too high Oil level is above maximum. P
Driving permitted e Have the fault corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.* Q
Inspection necessary
R
Oil level measurement Oil level measurement failure. S
fault e Have the fault corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.*
T
Driving permitted
Visit workshop U
V
Oil level low Minimum oil level is reached.
Add up to e Add oil. W
xx l > Please refer to chapter "Engine oil" on page 108. X
Oil pressure low Oil pressure is too low. Y
Park vehicle Z
259
Warning and Information Messages
260
Warning and Information Messages
261
Warning and Information Messages
P * Porsche recommends a Porsche partner as they have trained workshop personnel and the necessary parts and tools.
Q
R Vehicle
S Display Message Meaning and action required
T
Fault in vehicle electrical system.
U Vehicle electrical system fault
e Stop immediately in a suitable place.
Park vehicle
V e Do not continue driving.
safely
e Have the fault corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.*
W
X Engine run req. Fault in vehicle electrical system.
for electricity e Stop in a suitable place.
Y
Vehicle electrical system fault e Do not continue driving.
Z Park vehicle e Have the fault corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.*
262
Warning and Information Messages
263
Warning and Information Messages
G Vehicles with manual transmission: Start possible only when clutch pedal is
H Press clutch pressed.
e Press the clutch pedal when starting.
I
J Emergency call Emergency call function is faulty.
function fault e Have the fault corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.*
K
Service necessary
L
Driver Card not Driver Card was not detected.
M
found e Contact Security Operating Centre (SOC) if necessary.
N
Service reminder.
O Maintenance in xx e Bring the vehicle in for service no later than after the distance or time
P days shown has elapsed. The intervals in the "Guarantee and Maintenance"
booklet are decisive however.
Q
R Battery in the driver's key is flat.
e To start the vehicle, place the key at the front left in the storage com-
S partment in the centre console.
Key not found
T or key fault e Replace battery.
Hold back of key > Please refer to chapter "Driver's Key" on page 97.
U
against marked or
V area Key fault, key not found or not recognised.
or
W or Key position fault.
X Change key position e Switch off possible interference sources.
e Carry the driver's key with you.
Y – or –
Z Change key position in vehicle.
264
Warning and Information Messages
265
Warning and Information Messages
A Driving systems
B
Display Message Meaning and action required
C
D Chassis fault.
Chassis system fault
Vehicle handling may be affected.
E Adapted driving
Possible to drive on.
permitted. See
F e Adapt your driving style to the situation.
Driver's Manual.
G e Have the fault corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.*
H Chassis fault.
Chassis system fault
I Vehicle handling may be affected.
Visit workshop
J Possible to drive on.
Adapted driving
permitted e Adapt your driving style to the situation.
K e Have the fault corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.*
L
Chassis system Chassis failure.
M failed e Stop in a suitable place.
N Park vehicle e Do not continue driving.
safely e Have the fault corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.*
O
P PSM failure Porsche Stability Management (PSM) failure.
Q Visit workshop Possible to drive on.
lights up
Adapted driving e Adapt your driving style to the situation.
R permitted e Have the fault corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.*
S
ABS/PSM failure Porsche Stability Management (PSM) failure.
T
Possible to drive on.
lights up
U Adapted driving e Adapt your driving style to the situation.
V permitted e Have the fault corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.*
266
Warning and Information Messages
267
Warning and Information Messages
J Camera system Assistance systems or camera temporarily unavailable due to weather con-
K restricted ditions or dirt on the windscreen.
No camera view e Windscreen may need cleaning.
L
Clean windscreen If the fault persists:
M if necessary e Have the fault corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.*
N
System fault One or more electrical systems may have failed.
O Driving permitted e Adapt your driving style to the situation.
P Inspection necessary e Have the fault corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.*
Q ParkAssist Acoustic warning and distance signals (e.g. for ParkAssist) are not available.
R audio failure e Adapt your driving style to the situation.
or e Have the fault corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.*
S
Instrument cluster
T audio failure
U Driving permitted
Inspection necessary
V
W Front ParkAssist ParkAssist is not available.
failed e Adapt your driving style to the situation.
X
or e Possible problems when parking.
Y Rear ParkAssist e Have the fault corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.*
Z failed
268
Warning and Information Messages
269
Warning and Information Messages
K Speed limit display Speed limit display is temporarily unavailable due to weather conditions or
L currently limited dirt on the windscreen.
No camera view e Windscreen may need cleaning.
M
Clean windscreen If the fault persists:
N if necessary e Have the fault corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.*
O
Speed limit display Navigation data reception is temporarily unavailable.
P not available Possible to drive on.
Q Temporary status If the fault persists:
Driving permitted e Have the fault corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.*
R
or
S You are outside of the
T service area
U
or
V No navigation data
W available
X LCA not Lane Change Assist (LCA) is temporarily unavailable due to weather
available conditions.
Y
Temporary status e Activate Lane Change Assist (LCA) by pressing the button.
Z Driving permitted > Please refer to chapter "Lane Change Assist (LCA)" on page 132.
270
Warning and Information Messages
271
Warning and Information Messages
F * Porsche recommends a Porsche partner as they have trained workshop personnel and the necessary parts and tools.
G
H PCM
I Message Meaning and action required
J
A software update has failed.
K
Displays and comfort functions (e.g. ParkAssist) may not work fully.
L Critical fault! Please contact a quali- e Before using the vehicle, check that displays and comfort functions (e.g.
fied specialist workshop. ParkAssist) are working.
M
e Adapt your driving style to the situation.
N e Have the fault corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.*
O
A software update is installing.
P Displays and comfort functions (e.g. ParkAssist) may not work fully.
Update in progress. Avoid using the
Q e Stop in a suitable place.
vehicle.
e Do not continue driving.
R e Do not use the vehicle during the software update.
S
* Porsche recommends a Porsche partner as they have trained workshop personnel and the necessary parts and tools.
T
U
V
W
X
Y
Z
272
Windows
Windows Information A
B
Opening and closing windows If a side window is blocked by an object during
closing, it will stop and open again by several C
Opening and closing the centimetres.
WARNING D
windows If the side window is blocked a second time within
approx. 10 seconds, one-touch operation will be E
When opening or closing the windows, particularly in
disabled for this window. The side window can be
one-touch mode, parts of the body may get trapped closed manually. One-touch operation is enabled F
between the moving window and fixed vehicle parts. again once the side window has been closed com- G
e When opening and closing the windows, make pletely using the manual closing function.
sure that no parts of the body can become trap- H
ped between the moving window and fixed ve-
Opening and closing windows I
hicle parts.
e Always switch off the ignition when leaving the b Ignition switched on. J
vehicle. Uninformed persons could injure them- – or – K
selves by operating the power windows. b Ignition is switched off, but not for longer than
e In the event of danger, immediately release the 10 minutes. Fig. 221: Power window buttons in driver's door L
button on the driver’s key or the proximity sensor b Driver's or passenger's door not yet opened. A Power windows, driver’s side M
in the door handle on vehicles with Comfort B Power windows, passenger’s side
Access. C Switching between front/rear windows (Cabriolet) N
e Do not leave children in the vehicle unattended.
The rocker switches have a two-stage function. O
Closing a side window When actuating the buttons, both positions can be P
WARNING clearly felt through resistance when pulling or
manually
pressing. Q
If one-touch operation has been disabled following Stage one – manual operation R
blockage of a side window, the side window shuts e Press or pull the relevant rocker switch to the
with its full closing force during manual closing. S
first setting until the desired position is reached.
Parts of the body that become trapped between the The process stops when the switch is released. T
moving side window and fixed vehicle parts may be
crushed. Stage two – automatic operation U
e Make sure that nobody is trapped or crushed e Briefly push or pull the relevant rocker switch all V
the way to the second setting.
when closing the side windows.
The window opens or closes automatically to the W
end position. X
e Actuate the button again to stop the window at
the desired position. Y
Z
273
Windows
A Opening and closing windows with driver’s b Carry the driver's key with you, e.g. in your trou-
key ser pocket.
B
b Function activated.
C > Please refer to chapter "Vehicle Settings" on
page 246.
D
e Touch the proximity sensor in the door handle
E when locking the vehicle until the windows have
reached the desired position.
F
G Storing end position of windows
H The end positions of the windows are lost when the
battery is disconnected and reconnected. One-touch
I operation of the windows is disabled.
J Perform the following steps for all windows:
1. Close window completely once by pulling the
K
switch to the second setting.
L 2. When the window is completely closed, briefly
pull the rocker switch to the second setting
M
again.
N Fig. 222: Opening and closing windows with driver’s key 3. Completely open the window once by pressing
the switch.
O b Function activated.
P > Please refer to chapter "Vehicle Settings" on
page 246.
Q e Press and hold the button for locking and un-
locking the vehicle on the driver’s key until the
R
windows have reached the desired position.
S
Cabriolet: selecting windows
T e Press button C to select the front or rear
windows.
U
If the rear windows are selected, the indicator
V light on button C lights up.
W When the convertible top is open, the rear windows
can only be closed if the front windows are closed.
X
Closing windows with proximity sensor in
Y
door handle
Z b Vehicles with Comfort Access
274
Windscreen Wipers
Windscreen Wipers A
B
Brief overview
C
This brief overview does not replace the complete
D
information provided under "Windscreen wipers".
Safety messages and warnings, in particular, are not E
replaced by this brief overview.
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
Fig. 223: Windscreen wiper stalk Fig. 224: Switch for rain sensor/intermittent operation and O
rear wiper
P
What do I want to do? What do I have to do? Where? Q
Wipe automatically at front (rain sensor/intermit- e Press the stalk to detent position 1. > p. 276 R
tent operation) S
Set rain sensor/intermittent operation sensitivity e Press switch B on the right of the stalk upwards > p. 277 T
(wipe more often) or downwards (wipe less
U
often).
V
Wipe at front e Slow: Press the stalk to detent position 2. > p. 276
e Fast: Press the stalk to detent position 3. W
e Once: Briefly press the stalk to position 4 X
(holding stalk in position 4 accelerates wiping
action). Y
Z
275
Windscreen Wipers
O detent.
NOTICE 2 Windscreen wipers slow
P e Move wiper stalk upwards to the second
Risk of damage to luggage compartment lid, wind- detent.
Q 3 Windscreen wipers fast
screen and wiper system.
R e Move wiper stalk upwards to the third
e Only wipe the windscreen when sufficiently wet, detent.
S otherwise it could become scratched. 4 One-touch function for windscreen wipers
e Carefully detach frozen wiper blades from the e Press the wiper stalk downwards.
T
windscreen before driving. The windscreen wipers carry out one wiping
U e Always switch off windscreen wipers in car cycle.
washes to prevent them wiping unintentionally 5 Windscreen wipers and washer system
V Fig. 225: Windscreen wiper stalk
(rain sensor operation). e Pull wiper stalk towards the steering wheel.
W e Always hold the wiper arm securely when re- When the wiper stalk is released, a few
placing the wiper blade. drying wipes are performed.
X
e When replacing wiper blades, observe different After every 10 wipes, the camera is cleaned
Y lengths of the wiper blades. automatically as well.
Z
276
Windscreen Wipers
277
Windscreen Wipers
278
Technical Data
On the following pages, you will find the technical
data for your vehicle.
279
Technical Data
Technical Data
The information contained in this Manual may differ Identification plate (country-dependent) Tyre pressure plate
from the vehicle-specific data due to differing items
of equipment or for country-specific reasons. Unless
specified separately, it applies for all body variants.
For the vehicle-specific data, please refer to the of-
ficial vehicle registration documents and the infor-
mation plates (e.g. identification plate) in the vehicle.
The information in the official vehicle registration
documents always takes priority over the informa-
tion in this Manual.
Fig. 229: Identification plate fixing point Fig. 230: Tyre pressure plate fixing point
The tyre pressure plate is attached to the door sill
area at the driver’s door.
280
Technical Data
Dimensions
Length (depending on equipment) 4,519 mm – 4,533 mm
Width 1,852 mm
Filling capacities
Washer fluid Approx. 2.5 litres (vehicles with Night View Assist: approx. 3.5 litres)
Information
Depending on the country, the fuel consumption and emissions values applicable for the vehicle are contained in the vehicle documents provided during delivery of
the vehicle (e.g. "Certificate of Conformity"). The values indicated there were determined according to the specified measuring method (Euro 6: Regulation (EU) 715/
2007 in the current version; Euro 5: ECE-R 83 in conjunction with ECE-R 101 in the current versions).
281
Technical Data
Weights
e Vehicle-specific weights are shown on the identification plate or in the official vehicle registration documents (depending on country, e.g. "Certificate of Con-
formity") provided during delivery of the vehicle.
The identification plate is attached to the door sill area at the driver’s door.
e Do not exceed the maximum gross weight and maximum axle loads. If additional accessories are installed, the maximum permissible load will be reduced.
Roof load
e Only use roof transport systems that are from the Porsche Tequipment product line or that have been tested and approved by Porsche.
e Do not drive at a speed of more than 130 km/h (80 mph) when the roof transport system is loaded.
> Please refer to chapter "Roof Transport System" on page 195.
Coupé 75 kg
282
Technical Data
Tyre pressure
All tyre pressures apply only to the tyre makes and types approved by Porsche for cold tyres (20 °C).
The correct tyre pressures for factory-fitted tyres can be found on the tyre pressure plate. The specified tyre pressures for all other tyre options can be found on the
Tyre Pressure Monitoring (TPM) display in the PCM.
e Set tyre type, tyre size and load condition in the Tyre Pressure Monitoring (TPM) and select "Standard tyre pressure" or "Comfort tyre pressure" (depending on
country and equipment).
> Please refer to chapter "Tyre Pressure Monitoring (TPM)" on page 238.
e Refer to the tyre pressure plate and the Tyre Pressure Monitoring (TPM) display in the PCM.
– CAR e CONTROL e Vehicle e Tyre pressure monitoring e Pressure deviation
e Adapt the tyre pressure according to specifications.
Low tyre pressure
WARNING
The "Comfort pressure" option is country-dependent and is not available for all countries.
Driving at high speed and low tyre pressure destroys the tyres.
e Only set comfort pressure in the tyres on vehicles with "Comfort pressure" option.
Spare wheel
> Please refer to chapter "Using the collapsible spare wheel" on page 111.
Tyre pressure
All tyre pressures apply only to the tyre makes and types approved by Porsche for cold tyres (20 °C).
FA RA
Collapsible spare wheel 3.5 bar / 350 kPa / 51 psi 3.5 bar / 350 kPa / 51 psi
284
Technical Data
Format MPEG 1/2 Layer 3; Windows Media Audio 9 and 10; MPEG 2/4; FLAC, MPEG 1/2; ISO-MPEG4; DivX 3, 4 and 5; Xvid; ISO-MPEG4 H.264
(MPEG4 AVC); Windows Media Video 9
File extension .mp3; .wma; .asf; .m4a; .m4b; .aac; .flac; .mpg; .mpeg; .avi; .mp4; .m4v; .mov; .wmv
Characteristics max. 320 kbit/s and 48 kHz sampling frequency; max. 2,000 kbit/s and 720x576 px. at max. 25 fps
Number of files USB mass storage and memory cards max. 10,000 files per medium, max. 1,000 files per directory/playback list
Metadata Album covers up to 800 x 800 pixels; GIF, JPG and PNG formats or via Gracenote database
285
Technical Data
286
Technical Data
Recycling
Returning end-of-life vehicles
Only in European Union countries:
End-of-life Porsche end-of-life can be scrapped by
Dr. Ing. h.c. F. Porsche AG free of charge in an envi-
ronmentally friendly way. To return your vehicle and
obtain the relevant Certificate of Destruction:
e Contact your Porsche partner.
287
Radio equipment in accordance with 2014/53/EU
288
Radio equipment in accordance with 2014/53/EU
Radio system, frequency band, Porsche vehicle tracking system – driver card Gateway control unit – networking
maximum transmission power
Unless stated otherwise, the details apply to all 21.85 kHz < 40 dBμA/m @ 10m GSM 1800 1000.00 mW
models or vehicles that are equipped with the rele- (1710 – 1785 MHz)
vant radio1 system. Deviations are marked in the 433,85 – 433,99 MHz 10.00 mW
footnotes. GSM 1900 1000.00 mW
433,47 – 434,37 MHz 10.00 mW (1850 – 1910 MHz)
Security
Garage door opener (HomeLink®) EGPRS 850 501.19 mW
(824 – 849 MHz)
Driver’s key
433,05 – 434,79 MHz 10.00 mW
EGPRS 900 501.19 mW
21.85 kHz < 40 dBμA/m @ 10m
868,00 – 868,60 MHz 25.00 mW (880 – 915 MHz)
433,47 – 434,37 MHz 10.00 mW 868,70 – 869,20 MHz
869,40 – 869,65 MHz EGPRS 1800 398.11 mW
869,70 – 870,00 MHz (1710 – 1785 MHz)
Porsche vehicle tracking system – telematics
control unit EGPRS 1900 398.11 mW
Control units (1850 – 1910 MHz)
GSM 850 1995.26 mW
(824 – 849 MHz) Central control unit UMTS 1 251.19 mW
(1920 – 1980 MHz)
GSM 900 1995.26 mW 21.85 kHz < 40dBμA/m @ 10m
(880 – 915 MHz) UMTS 2 251.19 mW
125 kHz < 40dBμA/m @ 10m (1850 – 1910 MHz)
GSM 1800 1000.00 mW
(1710 – 1785 MHz) 433,05 – 434,79 MHz Receiver only UMTS 3 (9) 251.19 mW
(1710 – 1785 MHz)
GSM 1900 1000.00 mW
(1850 – 1910 MHz) Gateway control unit – networking
UMTS 4 251.19 mW
(1710 – 1755 MHz)
GSM 850 1995.25 mW
(824 – 849 MHz)
UMTS 5 (6) 251.19 mW
GSM 900 1995.25 mW (824 – 849 MHz)
(880 – 915 MHz)
UMTS 8 251.19 mW
(880 – 915 MHz)
1. In some countries, commissioning or approval for use of the radio technology may be restricted, not permitted or permitted with additional requirements.
289
Radio equipment in accordance with 2014/53/EU
Tyre Pressure Monitoring (TPM) system – gen. 3 (880 – 915 MHz) (880 – 915 MHz)
wheel electronics
LTE FDD1 199.53 mW LTE FDD1 200.00 mW
433,85 – 433,99 MHz 10.00 mW (1920 – 1980 MHz) (1920 – 1980 MHz)
Porsche Communication Management (PCM) LTE FDD7 199.53 mW LTE FDD7 200.00 mW
(2500 – 2570 MHz) (2500 – 2570 MHz)
WiFi 42.66 mW
(2400 – 2484 MHz) LTE FDD8 199.53 mW LTE FDD8 200.00 mW
(880 – 915 MHz) (880 – 915 MHz)
WiFi 35.89 mW
(5150 – 5250 MHz)1 LTE FDD20 199.53 mW LTE FDD20 200.00 mW
(832 – 862 MHz) (832 – 862 MHz)
WiFi 23.23 mW
(5725 – 5875 MHz) LTE FDD28 199.53 mW
(703 – 748 MHz)
Driver assistance
Bluetooth® 7.83 mW
(2400 – 2483.5 MHz) Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
Smartphone tray
GSM 900 1995.26 mW 76 – 77 GHz 981.75 mW
GSM 900 1995.25 mW
(880 – 915 MHz)
(800 – 915 MHz)
Lane Change Assist (LCA)
GSM 1800 1000 mW
GSM 1800 1000.00 mW
(1710 – 1785 MHz) 76 – 77 GHz 1000.00 mW
(1710 – 1785 MHz)
WCDMA I 251.19 mW
WCDMA I 125.00 mW
(1920 – 1980 MHz)
(1920 – 1980 MHz)
WCDMA III 251.19 mW
WCDMA III 125.00 mW
(1710 – 1785 MHz)
(1710 – 1785 MHz)
WCDMA VIII 251.19 mW
WCDMA VIII 125.00 mW
Antennas
WCDMA I 251.19 mW
(1920 – 1980 MHz)
291
Radio equipment outside European countries
Hong Kong
HKCA 1035: Automotive radar: radio equipment ex-
empted from licensing. CIDF15000490
CIDF17000143
Indonesia CIDF19000029
55538/SDPPI/2018
2208 Mexico
IFETEL: RLVPOPK17-1947
53856/SDPPI/2017 IFETEL: RLVBOLR14-1873
47817/SDPPI/2016 IFETEL: RLVDER316-1666
Israel Moldova
Model Name: TSSRE4Dg
Manufacturer: Huf Electronics Bretten Morocco
Model Name: LRR4 Numéro d´agrément :
Manufacturer: Bosch MR 17800 ANRT 2018
Date d´agrément : 24/10/2018
Japan
AGREE PAR L’ANRT MAROC
204-560001 Numéro d´agrément :
202-LSC054 MR 15019 ANRT 2017
202-JN0638 Date d´agrément : 26/10/2017
Japanese Radio Law Compliance. This device is Numéro d´agrément :
granted pursuant to the Japanese Radio Law. This MD OC TIP 024 A6116-18 MR 9668 ANRT 2014
device should not be modified (otherwise the Date d´agrément : 30/09/2014
granted designation number will become invalid). Numéro d´agrément :
MR 12623 ANRT 2016
Jamaica Date d´agrément : 11/10/2016
This product has been Type Approved by Jamaica: Numéro d’agrément: MR 19520 ANRT 2019
SMA - PK3. Date d’agrément: 13/04/2019
This product has been Type Approved by Jamaica:
SMA - BCMevo5. Oman
OMAN - TRA/TA-R/4813/17
Jordan D100428
TRC/LPD/2014/212 OMAN - TRA
TRC/LPD/2016/584 D172249
TRC/LPD/2017/615 TA056891
293
Radio equipment outside European countries
Pakistan
TA-2014/1784
APPROVED
TA-2016/2759
Paraguay
APPROVED
Qatar
Approval Ref.: CRA/SA/2015/R-4714 TA-2017/2491
Approval Ref.: CRA/SA/2014/R-4315 APPROVED
Russia TA-2019/5116
APPROVED
Модель: LTE-MBC-EU
Изготовитель: Molex CVS Dabendorf GmbH South Korea
Сделано в Германии
Электропитаие : 12 V=, 400 mA
Fig. 233:
Serbia
R-C-MQU-PK3
MSIP-REM-HEB-TSSSG4G5
MSIP-CRM-HEB-TSSRE4DG
BO-LRR4
MCIP-CRM-DDG-R3TR
송신기 주파수 21.85 kHz
34540-1020/17-3 B급 기기 (가정용 방송통신기자재)
34540-1313/16-3
294
Radio equipment outside European countries
295
Radio equipment outside European countries
Vietnam
296
Software licences
Software licences
Declaration on open source soft- source language processor. THE SOFTWARE IS CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER * TORTIOUS
ware for the instrument cluster - PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY ACTION, ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION
KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE * OF THIS
list of OSS components LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANT- SOFTWARE.
The instrument cluster contains components that ABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE,
are licensed as open source software. The affected TITLE AND NON-INFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT 3. EGLEXT Chromium
components and the associated licence conditions SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR ANYONE BSD 3-clause License
are listed below. The licensee receives a non-exclu- DISTRIBUTING THE SOFTWARE BE LIABLE FOR Copyright (c) YEAR, OWNER
sive right of use for the open source software from ANY DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN All rights reserved.
the respective copyright holders under the condi- CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM,
tions that provide for the relevant valid licence con- Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE
with or without modification, are permitted provided
ditions. The liability and warranty provisions of open OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE
source licences are only valid in relation to the re- that the following conditions are met:
SOFTWARE.
spective copyright holders. This list of open source Redistributions of source code must retain the above
program codes was compiled by reference to the 2. DRM CRTC copyright notice, this list of conditions and the fol-
third-party software that was integrated into the lowing disclaimer.
MIT Style License
services at the time the list was created. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
* Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
this software and its * documentation for any pur-
1. C11 Emulation Library following disclaimer in the documentation and/or
pose is hereby granted without fee, provided that * other materials provided with the distribution.
Boost Software License 1.0 the above copyright notice appear in all copies and
Boost Software License – Version 1.0 Neither the name of the ORGANIZATION nor the
that both that copyright * notice and this permission
names of its contributors may be used to endorse or
August 17th, 2003 notice appear in supporting documentation, and *
promote products derived from this software with-
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any that the name of the copyright holders not be used
out specific prior written permission.
person or organization obtaining a copy of the soft- in advertising or * publicity pertaining to distribution
of the software without specific, * written prior per- THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
ware and accompanying documentation covered by
mission. The copyright holders make no representa- HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND ANY
this license (the "Software") to use, reproduce, dis-
tions * about the suitability of this software for any EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING,
play, distribute, execute, and transmit the Software,
purpose. It is provided "as * is" without express or BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES
and to prepare derivative works of the Software, and
implied warranty. * * THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PAR-
to permit third-parties to whom the Software is fur-
DISCLAIM ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO TICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT
nished to do so, all subject to the following: The
THIS SOFTWARE, * INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WAR- SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR CONTRIBU-
copyright notices in the Software and this entire
RANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN TORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, IN-
statement, including the above license grant, this
NO * EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE CIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
restriction and the following disclaimer, must be in-
LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR * CONSE- CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT
cluded in all copies of the Software, in whole or in
QUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES WHAT- NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
part, and all derivative works of the Software, unless
SOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, * DATA GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
such copies or derivative works are solely in the form
OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOW-
of machine-executable object code generated by a
EVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,
297
Software licences
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR Unless otherwise noted in a file's first 5 lines, all This license was inspired by the BSD, Artistic, and
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) source code published on http://create.stephan- IJG (Independent JPEG Group) licenses, which all
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS brumme.com and its sub-pages is licensed similar to encourage inclusion and use of free software in
SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY the zlib license: This software is provided 'as-is', commercial and freeware products alike. As a con-
OF SUCH DAMAGE. without any express or implied warranty. In no event sequence, its main points are that:
will the author be held liable for any damages arising We don't promise that this software works. How-
4. Expat XML Parser-libexpat from the use of this software. Permission is granted ever, we will be interested in any kind of bug reports.
Expat License to anyone to use this software for any purpose, in- (`as is' distribution)
Copyright (c) 1998, 1999, 2000 Thai Open Source cluding commercial applications, and to alter it and You can use this software for whatever you want, in
Software Center Ltd and Clark Cooper redistribute it freely, subject to the following re- parts or full form, without having to pay us. (`roy-
Copyright (c) 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, strictions: The origin of this software must not be alty-free' usage)
2006 Expat maintainers. misrepresented; you must not claim that you wrote You may not pretend that you wrote this software. If
the original software. If you use this software in a you use it, or only parts of it, in a program, you must
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any
product, an acknowledgment in the product docu- acknowledge somewhere in your documentation
person obtaining a copy of this software and asso-
mentation would be appreciated but is not required. that you have used the FreeType code. (`credits')
ciated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal
Altered source versions must be plainly marked as
in the Software without restriction, including with- We specifically permit and encourage the inclusion
such, and must not be misrepresented as being the of this software, with or without modifications, in
out limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge,
original software. commercial products. We disclaim all warranties
publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of
the Software, and to permit persons to whom the covering The FreeType Project and assume no liabil-
6. Free Type ity related to The FreeType Project.
Software is furnished to do so, subject to the fol-
lowing conditions: Freetype Project License Finally, many people asked us for a preferred form
The above copyright notice and this permission no- The FreeType Project LICENSE for a credit/disclaimer to use in compliance with this
tice shall be included in all copies or substantial ——————————————————————- license. We thus encourage you to use the following
portions of the Software. —— text:
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT 2006-Jan-27 "Portions of this software are copyright © 1996-
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, Copyright 1996-2002, 2006 by 2002, 2006 The FreeType Project (www.freetype.
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRAN- David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg org). All rights reserved."
TIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PAR- Introduction Legal Terms
TICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN ============ ============
NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT The FreeType Project is distributed in several archive Definitions
HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES packages; some of them may contain, in addition to ————————————
OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF the FreeType font engine, various tools and contri- Throughout this license, the terms `package',
CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, butions which rely on, or relate to, the FreeType `FreeType Project', and `FreeType archive' refer to
OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE Project. the set of files originally distributed by the authors
OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE This license applies to all files found in such pack- (David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lem-
SOFTWARE. ages, and which do not fall under their own explicit berg) as the `FreeType Project', be they named as
license. The license affects thus the FreeType font alpha, beta or final release.
5. FASTCRC32 engine, the test programs, documentation and `You' refers to the licensee, or person using the
License of Stephan Brumme/Zlib style License makefiles, at the very least. project, where `using' is a generic term including
298
Software licences
compiling the project's source code as well as linking deletions or changes to the original files must be and distribution. If you are looking for support, start
it to form a `program' or `executable'. This program clearly indicated in accompanying documentation. in this list if you haven't found anything to help you
is referred to as `a program using the FreeType The copyright notices of the unaltered, original files in the documentation.
engine'. must be preserved in all copies of source files. devel@nongnu.org
This license applies to all files distributed in the Redistribution in binary form must provide a dis- Discusses bugs, as well as engine internals, design
original FreeType Project, including all source code, claimer that states that the software is based in part issues, specific licenses, porting, etc.
binaries and documentation, unless otherwise stated of the work of the FreeType Team, in the distribution Our home page can be found at
in the file in its original, unmodified form as distrib- documentation. We also encourage you to put an http://www.freetype.org
uted in the original archive. If you are unsure whether URL to the FreeType web page in your documenta- — end of FTL.TXT —
or not a particular file is covered by this license, you tion, though this isn't mandatory.
must contact us to verify this. These conditions apply to any software derived from 7. Freetype_BDF
The FreeType Project is copyright (C) 1996-2000, or based on the FreeType Project, not just the un-
The MIT License
2006 by David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner modified files. If you use our work, you must ac-
Lemberg. All rights reserved except as specified knowledge us. However, no fee need be paid to us. Copyright (c) year copyright holders
below. Advertising Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any
No Warranty person obtaining a copy of this software and asso-
————————————
ciated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal
———————————— Neither the FreeType authors and contributors nor in the Software without restriction, including with-
THE FREETYPE PROJECT IS PROVIDED `AS IS' you shall use the name of the other for commercial, out limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge,
WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EX- advertising, or promotional purposes without spe- publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of
PRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED cific prior written permission. the Software, and to permit persons to whom the
TO, WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FIT- We suggest, but do not require, that you use one or Software is furnished to do so, subject to the fol-
NESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. IN NO EVENT more of the following phrases to refer to this soft- lowing conditions:
WILL ANY OF THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT ware in your documentation or advertising materials: The above copyright notice and this permission no-
HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DAMAGES CAUSED `FreeType Project', `FreeType Engine', `FreeType li- tice shall be included in all copies or substantial
BY THE USE OR THE INABILITY TO USE, OF THE brary', or `FreeType Distribution'. portions of the Software.
FREETYPE PROJECT. As you have not signed this license, you are not re- THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT
Redistribution quired to accept it. However, as the FreeType Project WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED,
——————————————— is copyrighted material, only this license, or another INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRAN-
This license grants a worldwide, royalty-free, per- one contracted with the authors, grants you the right TIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PAR-
petual and irrevocable right and license to use, exe- to use, distribute, and modify it. Therefore, by using, TICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN
cute, perform, compile, display, copy, create distributing, or modifying the FreeType Project, you NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT
derivative works of, distribute and sublicense the indicate that you understand and accept all the HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES
FreeType Project (in both source and object code terms of this license. OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF
forms) and derivative works thereof for any purpose; Contacts CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM,
and to authorize others to exercise some or all of the ————————— OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE
rights granted herein, subject to the following There are two mailing lists related to FreeType: OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE
conditions: freetype@nongnu.org SOFTWARE.
Redistribution of source code must retain this li- Discusses general use and applications of FreeType,
cense file (`FTL.TXT') unaltered; any additions, as well as future and wanted additions to the library
299
Software licences
8. FreeType_PCF shall be included in all copies or substantial portions an acknowledgment in the product documentation
The MIT License of the Software. would be appreciated but is not required.
> Please refer to chapter "7. Freetype_BDF" on THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT 2. Altered source versions must be plainly marked as
page 299. WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, such, and must not be misrepresented as being the
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRAN- original software.
9. HarfBuzz TIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PAR- 3. This notice may not be removed or altered from
The MIT License TICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN any source distribution.
> Please refer to chapter "7. Freetype_BDF" on NO EVENT SHALL SILICON GRAPHICS, INC. BE LI-
page 299. ABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LI- 15. Libva
ABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, The MIT License
10. Intel DVO i915 TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR > Please refer to chapter "7. Freetype_BDF" on
IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE page 299.
MIT Style License
USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
> Please refer to chapter "2. DRM CRTC" on
page 297. Except as contained in this notice, the name of Sili- 16. Linus Graphics Drivers from Intel – Kernel
con Graphics, Inc. shall not be used in advertising or DRM-bsd
11. Khronos EGL Headers otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings
The MIT License
The MIT License
in this Software without prior written authorization > Please refer to chapter "7. Freetype_BDF" on
from Silicon Graphics, Inc.
> Please refer to chapter "7. Freetype_BDF" on page 299.
page 299.
13. libdrm 17. lua
12. Khronos Group-OpenGL ES The MIT License The MIT License
> Please refer to chapter "7. Freetype_BDF" on
SGI Free Software License B v2.0 > Please refer to chapter "7. Freetype_BDF" on
page 299. page 299.
SGI FREE SOFTWARE LICENSE B (Version 2.0, Sept.
18, 2008) 14. libunibreak
Copyright (C) [dates of first publication] Silicon 18. lz4 Compression algorithm
zlib License BSD 2-clause "Simplified" License
Graphics, Inc. All Rights Reserved.
The zlib/libpng License Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any
Copyright (c) year copyright holders with or without modification, are permitted provided
person obtaining a copy of this software and asso-
ciated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal This software is provided 'as-is', without any express that the following conditions are met:
in the Software without restriction, including with- or implied warranty. In no event will the authors be Redistributions of source code must retain the above
out limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, held liable for any damages arising from the use of copyright notice, this list of conditions and the fol-
publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of this software. lowing disclaimer.
the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Permission is granted to anyone to use this software Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
Software is furnished to do so, subject to the fol- for any purpose, including commercial applications, above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
lowing conditions: and to alter it and redistribute it freely, subject to the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or
The above copyright notice including the dates of following restrictions: other materials provided with the distribution.
first publication and either this permission notice or 1. The origin of this software must not be misrepre- THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR
a reference to http://oss.sgi.com/projects/FreeB/ sented; you must not claim that you wrote the orig- "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRAN-
inal software. If you use this software in a product, TIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
300
Software licences
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND developed by the University of California, Berkeley THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND DIGITAL
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DIS- and its contributors. EQUIPMENT CORP. DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES
CLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, of its contributors may be used to endorse or pro- ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAM- mote products derived from this software without AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL DIGITAL
AGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PRO- specific prior written permission. EQUIPMENT CORPORATION BE LIABLE FOR ANY
CUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RE-
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT SULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MER- WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLI-
STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLI- CHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR GENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
GENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR
OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,
EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (IN- 21. PCFUtil
19. Mesa3D – MesaLib CLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT Open Group License
The MIT License OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF Copyright 1996, 1998 The Open Group
> Please refer to chapter "7. Freetype_BDF" on USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUP- Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell
page 299. TION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY this software and its documentation for any purpose
OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LI- is hereby granted without fee, provided that the
20. NetBSD ABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
BSD-4-Clause (University of California-Specific) OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE both that copyright notice and this permission no-
BSD-4-Clause (University of California-Specific) USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE tice appear in supporting documentation.
Copyright [various years] The Regents of the Uni- POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. The above copyright notice and this permission no-
versity of California. All rights reserved. BSD 3-clause tice shall be included in all copies or substantial
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, > Please refer to chapter "3. EGLEXT Chromium" portions of the Software.
with or without modification, are permitted provided on page 297. THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT
that the following conditions are met: HPND Like License WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED,
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the Portions Copyright (c) 1993 by Digital Equipment INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRAN-
above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the Corporation. TIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PAR-
following disclaimer. Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this TICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the software for any purpose with or without fee is NO EVENT SHALL THE OPEN GROUP BE LIABLE
above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the hereby granted, provided that the above copyright FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY,
following disclaimer in the documentation and/or notice and this permission notice appear in all cop- WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR
other materials provided with the distribution. ies, and that the name of Digital Equipment Corpo- OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CON-
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or ration not be used in advertising or publicity NECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR
use of this software must display the following ac- pertaining to distribution of the document or soft- OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
knowledgement: This product includes software ware without specific, written prior permission. Except as contained in this notice, the name of The
Open Group shall not be used in advertising or
301
Software licences
otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, * SPECIAL, EXEM-
in this Software without prior written authorization PLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUD-
from The Open Group. ING, BUT * NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; * LOSS OF USE,
22. static_drm_mode DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
The MIT License HOWEVER * CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LI-
> Please refer to chapter "7. Freetype_BDF" on ABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, * STRICT LI-
page 299. ABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR
OTHERWISE) * ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE
23. Video Accelarator USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF * ADVISED OF
BSD Style License THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
Redistribution. Redistribution and use in binary form,
24. zlib
without modification, are * permitted provided that
the following conditions are met: * Redistributions Zlib license
must reproduce the above copyright notice and the > Please refer to chapter "14. libunibreak" on
following * disclaimer in the documentation and/or page 300.
other materials provided with the * distribution. *
Neither the name of Intel Corporation nor the names
of its suppliers may be used * to endorse or promote
products derived from this software without specific
prior * written permission. * No reverse engineering,
decompilation, or disassembly of this software is
permitted. * Limited patent license. Intel Corporation
grants a world-wide, royalty-free, * nonexclusive li-
cense under patents it now or hereafter owns or
controls to make, have made, * use, import, offer to
sell and sell (.Utilize.) this software, but solely to the
extent that any * such patent is necessary to Utilize
the software alone. The patent license shall not ap-
ply * to any combinations which include this soft-
ware. No hardware per se is licensed here under. *
DISCLAIMER. THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY
THE COPYRIGHT * HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
"AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED * WAR-
RANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
IMPLIED * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR * PURPOSE ARE
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT
OWNER * OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
302
Index
303
Index
304
Index
305
Index
306
Index
Jack
Automatic headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
Care instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 M
Lifting the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 Changing bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 Maintenance work
Jump-lead starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129-130 Dipped beams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 Adding engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
External power supply (lead battery) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129 Direction indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 Adding washer fluid. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
External power supply (lithium battery) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130 Dynamic high beam. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 Malfunctions
Encounter lights. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 Power windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
K Entry function/Exit function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Exterior lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
Storing end position of windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
Key Manual transmission
Lifting and closing the slide/tilt roof. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207 Fog function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 Upshift indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
Locking vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 Full beam assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 Map (Navigation)
Opening/closing convertible top . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 Hazard warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 Calling up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Removing the emergency key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 High beam . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 Configuring. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Storing and retrieving personal settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 Interior lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 Matrix Beam. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Unlocking vehicle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 Matrix Beam . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Motorway function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Keyboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179 Browsing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Overseas mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
Kombiinstrument Connecting an external device via USB . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Passing lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Warning and indicator lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Making settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
Porsche Dynamic Light System Plus (PDLS Plus) . . . . 141-
142 Playing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Ports in the armrest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
307
Index
308
Index
PCM phone. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 Porsche Doppelkupplung (PDK) Rear seat storage space . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
Setting time or temperature display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179 Operating mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 Rear spoiler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Switching on PCM phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182 Shifting gears on the steering wheel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 Operating principle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Switching on telephone function. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182 Porsche Dynamic Light System Plus (PDLS Plus) . . . . 141-142 Rear Turn Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Touch display in dashboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 Porsche Road Trip app . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Rear window
Using PCM WiFi hotspot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Porsche Stability Management (PSM) Switching heating on/off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
PCM hotspot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 Functional description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185 Rear window wiper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
PCM phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 Switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185 Reverse function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
PDK. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 Porsche Track Precision App . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 Refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Shifting gears on the steering wheel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 Porsche Vehicle Tracking System (PVTS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188 Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
PDLS Plus. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141-142 Porsche Vehicle Tracking System Plus (PVTS Plus) . . . . . . . . 188 Identification for location of filler flap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Petrol Porsche Wet Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Lifting and closing the slide/tilt roof. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
Ports in the armrest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Fuel reserve warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Locking vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
SD card reader . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
Octane rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 Opening/closing convertible top . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
SIM card reader . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
Quality. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 USB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 Unlocking vehicle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 Retractable rear spoiler
Power windows
Petrol octane rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 Extending and retracting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Closing windows using proximity sensor in door handle
Phone (vehicles with Comfort Access). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274 Retrieving personal settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Breakdown call. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 Opening/closing windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273 Reversing camera . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Connecting via Bluetooth® (Windows® and iOS operating Opening/closing windows with driver's key (remote Roll-over protection (Cabriolet). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
system) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224 control) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274 Roll-up sunblind
Planning a tour (Navigation) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 Storing end position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274 Opening/closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
Plug socket (12 V) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 Private mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 Roof transport system
Porsche Active Safe Program guide (EPG) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 Fitting basic carrier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Preventive occupant protection function . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 Protective films . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 Transporting a load on the roof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Setting the distance warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 Care instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Setting the warning time for the collision warning . . . . 172 PSM (Porsche Stability Management)
Switching on/off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
Switching the collision warning off and on . . . . . . . . . . 172
Functional description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
S
Warning and brake assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 SAFELOCK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
PSM Sport . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185 Deactivating with proximity sensor on door handle . . . . 71
Porsche Active Suspension Management (PASM) Switching on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Functional description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 Deactivating with the driver's key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Pushing the emergency key. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 Saving
Porsche Ceramic Composite Brake (PCCB). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Personal settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Porsche Communication Management (PCM)
Opening manual in vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 R Screens
Operating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 Race-Tex Care instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Touch display in dashboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 Care instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 SD card reader. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
Porsche Connect Radar sensor Sealant/sealing set
Establishing data connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182 Adaptive cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 For defective tyres. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Logging in user (Porsche ID) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 Radio. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 Seals
Managing user (Porsche ID) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 Online radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 Care instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
PCM phone. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 Setting frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 Seat belts
Private mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 Storing/editing a favourite . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 Care instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 Tuning/storing stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 Fastening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
Using services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 Rear fog light Notes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
Porsche Connect App . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 Adaptation of light distribution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 Opening seat-belt buckle and removing seat belt . . . . . 201
Connecting to PCM via WiFi . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 Switching on/off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 Seat-belt pretensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
309
Index
Warning light on the tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 Snow chains Switching on telephone function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
Warning message . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 General information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 Switching seat heating on/off. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
Seat memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 Spare wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Switching seat ventilation on/off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
Seat-belt pretensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 Spoiler Switching steering wheel heating on/off. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Seats Operating principle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Adjusting front seat. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Adjusting seat position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Sport Chrono mode switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Sport Chrono stopwatch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
T
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Baby carrier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 Sport exhaust system. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Folding rear seat backrest forward or back . . . . . . . . . . 205 Technical data
SPORT mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 CO2 emissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
Folding seat backrest forward or back . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
Storing and retrieving the seat position . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 SPORT PLUS mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 Filling capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
Standard pressure Fuel consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
Selecting a source (media) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Selecting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 Tyre pressure tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
Selecting access point (APN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182 Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
Start Stop function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Selecting APN (access point) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182 Wheel and tyre sizes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
Starting
Service history Telephone
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
Displaying . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246 Connecting via Bluetooth® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
Steering column lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Service position. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 Connecting via Bluetooth® (known mobile phone) . . . . 224
Steering wheel
Setting automatic air-recirculation mode Connecting via Bluetooth® (new mobile phone). . . . . . . 223
Adjusting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Air-conditioning system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 Connecting via Bluetooth® (second mobile phone) . . . . 224
Assigning ◊ button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Setting speed limit on instrument cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 Connection status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
Steering lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
Setting speed warning on instrument cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 Device Manager . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Switching heating on/off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Dialling a number. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
Settings Stopping Emergency call. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Storing and retrieving personal settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216 Functions during a phone call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246 Stopping engine automatically (Auto Start Stop function) Inserting external SIM card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
Shifting gears (vehicles with manual transmission) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 Making settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
Manual transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236 Stopping the engine automatically (Auto Start Stop Managing contacts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
Porsche Doppelkupplung (PDK). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 function) (Vehicles with PDK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Phone settings on the instrument cluster . . . . . . . . . . . 225
Side lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 Stopwatch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213 Storing/editing a favourite . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
Signage glare reduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 Storage compartment Stowing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
SIM card Opening in the front armrest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220 Using PCM with a SIM card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
Establishing data connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182 Storage options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219 Test stands
Using the phone. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 Storage options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219 Brake test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
SIM card reader . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 Storage compartment in front armrest. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220 Brake testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
Siri. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 Storing end position of power windows. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274 Theft protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Slide/tilt roof Storing end position of sun blind . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 Tightening torque
Cleaning the air deflector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209 Storing end position of the slide/tilt roof. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 Wheel bolts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
Closing if roof drive mechanism fails . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 Storing/editing a favourite Toll devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
Emergency operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 Media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 Tool kit
Functional description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 Telephone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225 Removing and stowing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
Lifting and closing the slide/tilt roof with the driver’s Stowing mobile phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207 Summer tyre
Storing end position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 Top tether
Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 Installing child restraint system with top tether . . . . . . . 81
Smart routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 Sun blind Installing child restraint systems with ISOFIX tether . . . 81
Smartphone Storing end position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 Torque
Connecting via Bluetooth® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223 Sun visor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 Tightening torque for wheel bolts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
Stowing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
Switching automatic anti-dazzle function on and off. . . . . . . 158 Touch display
Smoker's package . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210 Care instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Switching exterior mirror heating on/off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
310
Index
Modifying display. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246 Fixing a flat tyre. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 Vehicle identification number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
Operating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 Inscription on tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 Vehicle settings
Touch display in dashboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 Replacing tyres (general information) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242 Adjust seat heating, seat ventilation and seat
Home screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 Sealant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Info widget . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 Selecting comfort or standard pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 Adjust volume of warning signals and ParkAssist . . . . . 246
Towing Setting full load or partial load. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 Changing button assignment on multi-function steering
General information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228 Setting tyre type and tyre size. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 wheel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Towing lug . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229 Snow chains (general information) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 Configuring. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Using a towing rope or towing bar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229 Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 Displaying pressure deviation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Teaching in new tyres in Tyre Pressure Monitoring Modifying instrument cluster display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Towing lug
(TPM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 Modifying PCM display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
In tool kit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
Tread depth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 Reset to factory settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
TPM (Tyre Pressure Monitoring) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 Tyre pressure plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280 Set date and time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Traffic notices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 Valves . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242 Set the language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Traffic sign detection Winter tyres (general information) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242 Set the voice control system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Bend ahead warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231 Set units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Displaying speed limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
Transmission
U Setting car jack mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Setting door locking options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Underbody protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Manual transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236 Setting tyre type and tyre size. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Care instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Porsche Doppelkupplung (PDK). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 Storing on person buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Unlocking Tyre Pressure Monitoring (TPM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Transport (on car trains, ferries, etc.)
Emergency unlocking of vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Securing the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230 Video
Unlocking and opening luggage compartment lid . . . . . 149
Tray (phone) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 Supported data formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
Unlocking vehicle from inside . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Tread depth Unlocking vehicle with Comfort Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 Voice control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
Tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 Unlocking vehicle with driver's key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 Adapting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
Tuning/storing stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 Calling up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
Unlocking and locking the steering wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Type of climate control Saying commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
Upper ventilation panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Adjusting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 USB connection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180-181 Siri . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Tyre filling compressor
Voice commands for air conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
Removing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
Stowing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
V Voice commands for apps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
Valves Voice commands for calendar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
Tyre pressure Tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242 Voice commands for media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 Voice commands for navigation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
Vanity mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
Displaying in instrument cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 Voice commands for online music services . . . . . . . . . . 254
Speed warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239 Vehicle
Emergency locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 Voice commands for radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
System is learning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 Voice commands for telephone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
Emergency unlocking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Tyre Pressure Monitoring (TPM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
Locking from inside . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Displaying . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Teaching-in . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Locking with Comfort Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 W
Locking with the driver's key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 Warning and brake assist
Tyre pressure plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280 Unlocking with Comfort Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 Porsche Active Safe (PAS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
Tyre pressure tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283 Unlocking with driver's key. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 Warning and information messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
Tyre pressure warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Vehicle data carrier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280 Driving systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
Tyre sealant/sealing set Vehicle door Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
For defective tyres. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 Locking with Comfort Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 PCM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
Tyre sealing compound Opening. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
Removing and stowing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 Opening and locking from inside . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
Tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 Unlocking from inside . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 Warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Checking tyre pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 Vehicle hotspot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 Warning triangle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
Displaying pressure deviation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
311
Index
312